Mathematics
Mathematics
Mathematics
Textbook for Class VII
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
no
2020-21
ISBN 81-7450-669-1
November 2012 Kartika 1934 q The correct price of this publication is the price printed on this page, Any
revised price indicated by a rubber stamp or by a sticker or by any other
October 2013 Asvina 1935 means is incorrect and should be unacceptable.
November 2014 Agrahayana 1936
December 2015 Agrahayana 1937
December 2016 Pausa 1938
November 2017 Agrahayana 1939 OFFICES OF THE PUBLICATION
January 2019 Pausha 1940 DIVISION, NCERT
August 2019 Bhadrapada 1941 NCERT Campus
Sri Aurobindo Marg
d
New Delhi 110 016 Phone : 011-26562708
he
PD 1000T RPS 108, 100 Feet Road
pu T Hosdakere Halli Extension
Banashankari III Stage
Bengaluru 560 085 Phone : 080-26725740
is
re ER
© National Council of Educational
Research and Training, 2007 bl Navjivan Trust Building
P.O.Navjivan
Ahmedabad 380 014 Phone : 079-27541446
be NC
CWC Campus
Opp. Dhankal Bus Stop
Panihati
Kolkata 700 114 Phone : 033-25530454
CWC Complex
©
Maligaon
Guwahati 781 021 Phone : 0361-2674869
o
Publication Team
tt
` 65.00
Head, Publication : M. Siraj Anwar
no
Division
Chief Editor : Shveta Uppal
Chief Production : Arun Chitkara
Officer
Printed on 80 GSM paper with NCERT Chief Business : Bibash Kumar Das
watermark Manager
Published at the Publication Division by Editor : Bijnan Sutar
the Secretary, National Council of
Educational Research and Training, Production Assistant : Om Prakash
Sri Aurobindo Marg, New Delhi 110 016
and printed at A nand Publications, Cover Illustrations
106/1/A , Nusali Fata, N.H. 06, Shweta Rao Prashant Soni
Duwe Road, Tal. Dharangaon, District
Jalgaon - 425 103
2020-21
iii
Foreword
The National Curriculum Framework (NCF), 2005, recommends that children’s life at school must be
linked to their life outside the school. This principle marks a departure from the legacy of bookish
learning which continues to shape our system and causes a gap between the school, home and
community. The syllabi and textbooks developed on the basis of NCF signify an attempt to implement
this basic idea. They also attempt to discourage rote learning and the maintenance of sharp boundaries
between different subject areas. We hope these measures will take us significantly further in the
direction of a child-centred system of education outlined in the National Policy on Education (1986).
The success of this effort depends on the steps that school principals and teachers will take to
encourage children to reflect on their own learning and to pursue imaginative activities and questions. We
must recognise that, given space, time and freedom, children generate new knowledge by engaging with
the information passed on to them by adults. Treating the prescribed textbook as the sole basis of examination
is one of the key reasons why other resources and sites of learning are ignored. Inculcating creativity and
d
initiative is possible if we perceive and treat children as participants in learning, not as receivers of a fixed
he
body of knowledge. pu T
These aims imply considerable change in school routines and mode of functioning. Flexibility in
is
re ER
the daily time-table is as necessary as rigour in implementing the annual calendar so that the required
bl
number of teaching days are actually devoted to teaching. The methods used for teaching and evaluation
will also determine how effective this textbook proves for making children’s life at school a happy
be NC
experience, rather than a source of stress or boredom. Syllabus designers have tried to address the
problem of curricular burden by restructuring and reorienting knowledge at different stages with
greater consideration for child psychology and the time available for teaching. The textbook attempts
to enhance this endeavour by giving higher priority and space to opportunities for contemplation and
©
Chairperson of the advisory group in science and mathematics, Professor J.V. Narlikar and the Chief
tt
Advisor for this book, Dr H.K. Dewan for guiding the work of this committee. Several teachers
no
contributed to the development of this textbook; we are grateful to their principals for making this
possible. We are indebted to the institutions and organisations which have generously permitted us to
draw upon their resources, material and personnel. We are especially grateful to the members of the
National Monitoring Committee, appointed by the Department of Secondary and Higher Education,
Ministry of Human Resource Development under the Chairpersonship of Professor Mrinal Miri and
Professor G.P. Deshpande, for their valuable time anc contribution. As an organisation committed to
systemic reform and continuous improvement in the quality of its products, NCERT welcomes comments
and suggestions which will enable us to undertake further revision and refinement.
Director
New Delhi National Council of Educational
20 November 2006 Research and Training
2020-21
no
tt ©
o
be NC
2020-21
re ER
pu T
bl
is
he
d
v
Preface
The National Curriculum Framework (NCF), 2005 suggests the need for developing the ability for
mathematisation in the child. It points out that the aim of learning mathematics is not merely being
able to do quantitative calculations but also to develop abilities in the child that would enable her/him
to redefine her/his relationship with the World. The NCF-2005 also lays emphasis on development in
the children logical abilities as well as abilities to comprehend space, spatial transformations and
develop the ability to visualise both these. It recommends that mathematics needs to slowly move
towards abstraction even though it starts from concrete experiences and models. The ability to
generalise and perceive patterns is an important step in being able to relate to the abstract and logic
governed nature of the subject.
We also know that most children in upper primary and secondary classes develop a fear of
mathematics and it is one of the reasons for students not being able to continue in schools.
NCF-2005 has also mentioned this problem and has therefore emphasised the need to develop a
programme which is relevant and meaningful. The need for conceptualising mathematics teaching
d
allows children to explore concepts as well as develop their own ways of solving problems. This also
he
forms corner-stone of the principles highlighted in the NCF-2005.
pu T
In Class VI we have begun the process of developing a programme which would help
is
children understand the abstract nature of mathematics while developing in them the ability to construct
re ER
their own concepts. As suggested by NCF-2005, an attempt has been made to allow multiple ways of
bl
solving problems and encouraging children to develop strategies different from each other.
be NC
There is an emphasis on working with basic principles rather than on memorisation of algorithms
and short-cuts.
The Class VII textbook has continued that spirit and has attempted to use language which the
children can read and understand themselves. This reading can be in groups or individual and at some
©
places require help and support by the teacher. We also tried to include a variety of examples and
opportunities for children to set problems. The appearance of the book has sought to be made pleasant
by including many illustrations. The book attempts to engage the mind of the child actively and provides
opportunities to use concepts and develop her/his own structures rather than struggling with
o
We hope that this book would help all children in their attempt to learn mathematics and would
no
build in them the ability to appreciate its power and beauty. We also hope that this would enable to
revisit and consolidate concepts and skills that they have learnt in the primary school. We hope to
strengthen the foundation of mathematics, on which further engagement with studies as well as her
daily life would become possible in an enriched manner.
The team in developing the textbook consists of many teachers who are experienced and brought
to the team the view point of the child and the school. We also had people who have done research in
learning of mathematics and those who have been writing textbooks for mathematics for many years.
The team has tried to make an effort to remove fear of mathematics from the minds of children and
make it a part of their daily routine even outside the school. We had many discussions and a review
process with some other teachers of schools across the country. The effort by the team has been to
accommodate all the comments.
In the end, I would like to place on record our gratefulness to Prof Krishna Kumar, Director,
NCERT, Prof G. Ravindra, Joint Director, NCERT and Prof Hukum Singh, Head, DESM, for giving
opportunity to me and the team to work on this challenging task. I am also grateful to
2020-21
vi
Prof J.V. Narlikar, Chairperson of the Advisory Group in Science and Mathematics for his suggestions.
I am also grateful for the support of all those who were part of this team including Prof S.K. Singh
Gautam, Dr V.P. Singh and Dr Ashutosh K. Wazalwar from NCERT, who have worked very hard to
make this possible. In the end I must thank the Publication Department of NCERT for its support and
advice and those from Vidya Bhawan who helped produce the book.
The process of developing materials is a continuous one and we would hope to make this book
better. Suggestions and comments on the book are most welcome.
Dr H.K. Dewan
Chief Advisor
Textbook Development Committee
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
no
2020-21
vii
This book is a continuation of the process and builds on what was initiated in Class VI. We had shared
with you the main points reflected in NCF-2005. These include relating mathematics to a wider
development of abilities in children, moving away from complex calculations and algorithms following,
to understanding and constructing a framework of understanding. The mathematical ideas in the mind
of the child grow neither by telling nor by merely giving explanations. For children to learn mathematics,
to be confident in it and understand the foundational ideas, they need to develop their own framework
of concepts. This would require a classroom where children discuss ideas, look for solutions of problems,
set new problems and find not only their own ways of solving problems but also their own definitions
with the language they can use and understand. These definitions need not be as general and complete
as the standard ones.
In the mathematics class it is important to help children read with understanding the textbook and
other references. The reading of materials is not normally considered to be related to learning of
d
mathematics but learning mathematics any further would require the child to comprehend the text.
he
The text in mathematics uses a language that has brevity. It requires the ability to deal with terseness
pu T
and with symbols, to follow logical arguments and appreciate the need for keeping certain factors and
constraints. Children need practice in translating mathematical statements into normal statements
is
re ER
expressing ideas in words and vice-a-versa. We would require children to become confident of using
bl
language in words and also being able to communicate through mathematical statements.
be NC
Mathematics at the upper primary stage is a major challenge and has to perform the dual role of
being both close to the experience and environment of the child and being abstract. Children often are
not able to work in terms of ideas alone. They need the comfort of context and/or models linked to
their experience to find meaning. This stage presents before us the challenge of engaging the children
©
while using the contexts but gradually moving them away from such dependence. So while children
should be able to identify the principles to be used in a contextual situation, they should not be dependent
or be limited to contexts. As we progress further in the middle school there would be greater requirement
from the child to be able to do this.
o
Learning mathematics is not about remembering solutions or methods but knowing how to solve
tt
problems. Problem-solving strategies give learners opportunities to think rationally, enabling them to
understand and create methods as well as processes; they become active participants in the construction
no
of new knowledge rather than being passive receivers. Learners need to identify and define a problem,
select or design possible solutions and revise or redesign the steps, if required. The role of a teacher
gets modified to that of a guide and facilitator. Students need to be provided with activities and challenging
problems, along with sets of many problem-solving experiences.
On being presented a problem, children first need to decode it. They need to identify the knowledge
required for attempting it and build a model for it. This model could be in the form of an illustration or
a situation construct. We must remember that for generating proofs in geometry the figures constructed
are also models of the ideal dimensionless figure. These diagrams are, however, more abstract than
the concrete models required for attempting problems in arithmetic and algebra. Helping children to
develop the ability to construct appropriate models by breaking up the problems and evolving their own
strategies and analysis of problems is extremely important. This should replace prescriptive algorithms
to solve problems.
Teachers are expected to encourage cooperative learning. Children learn a lot in purposeful
conversation with each other. Our classrooms should develop in the students the desire and capacity
to learn from each other rather than compete. Conversation is not noise and consultation is not cheating.
It is a challenge to make possible classroom groups that benefit the most from being with each other
2020-21
viii
and in which each child contributes to the learning of the group. Teachers must recognise that different
children and different groups will use distinct strategies. Some of these strategies would appear to be
more efficient and some not as efficient. They would reflect the modelling done by each group and
would indicate the process of thinking used. It is inappropriate to identify the best strategy or pull down
incorrect strategies. We need to record all strategies adopted and analyse them. During this, it is
crucial to discuss why some of the strategies are unsuccessful. The class as a group can improve upon
the ineffective and unsuccessful strategies and correct them. This implies that we need to complete
each strategy rather than discard some as incorrect or inappropriate. Exposures to a variety of strategies
would deepen mathematical understanding and ability to learn from others. This would also help them
to understand the importance of being aware of what one is doing.
Enquiry to understand is one of the natural ways by which students acquire and construct knowledge.
The process can even begin with casual observations and end in generation and acquisition of knowledge.
This can be aided by providing examples for different forms of questioning-explorative, open-ended,
contextual, error detection etc. Students need to get exposed to challenging investigations. For example
in geometry there could be things like, experimenting with suitable nets for solids, visualising solids
through shadow play, slicing and elevations etc. In arithmetic we can make them explore relationships
among members, generalise the relationships, discover patterns and rules and then form algebraic
relations etc.
d
Children need the opportunity to follow logical arguments and find loopholes in the arguments
he
presented. This will lead them to understand the requirement of a proof.
pu T
At this stage topics like Geometry are poised to enter a formal stage. Provide activities that
is
re ER
encourage students to exercise creativity and imagination while discovering geometric vocabulary and
relationships using simple geometric tools.
bl
Mathematics has to emerge as a subject of exploration and creation rather than an exercise of
be NC
finding answers to old and complicated problems. There is a need to encourage children to find many
different ways to solve problems. They also need to appreciate the use of many alternative algorithms
and strategies that may be adopted to solve a problem.
Topics like Integers, Fractions and Decimals, Symmetry have been presented here by linking them
©
with their introductory parts studied in earlier classes. An attempt has been made to link chapters with
each other and the ideas introduced in the initial chapters have been used to evolve concepts in the
subsequent chapters. Please devote enough time to the ideas of negative integers, rational numbers,
exploring statements in Geometry and visualising solids shapes.
o
We hope that the book will help children learn to enjoy mathematics and be confident in the
tt
concepts introduced. We want to recommend the creation of opportunity for thinking individually and
no
collectively. Group discussions need to become a regular feature of mathematics classroom thereby
making learners confident about mathematics and make the fear of mathematics a thing of past.
We look forward to your comments and suggestions regarding the book and hope that you will
send interesting exercises, activities and tasks that you develop during the course of teaching, to be
included in the future editions.
2020-21
ix
CHIEF ADVISOR
H.K. Dewan, Vidya Bhawan Society, Udaipur, Rajasthan
CHIEF COORDINATOR
Hukum Singh, Professor and Head (Retd.), DESM, NCERT, New Delhi
MEMBERS
Anjali Gupte, Teacher, Vidya Bhawan Public School, Udaipur, Rajasthan
d
Avantika Dam, TGT, CIE Experimental Basic School, Department of Education, Delhi
he
pu T
H.C. Pradhan, Professor, Homi Bhabha Centre for Science Education, TIFR, Mumbai,
Maharashtra
is
re ER
Mahendra Shankar, Lecturer (S.G.) (Retd.), NCERT, New Delhi
bl
Meena Shrimali, Teacher, Vidya Bhawan Senior Secondary School, Udaipur, Rajasthan
be NC
Shradha Agarwal, PGT, Sir Padampat Singhania Education Centre, Kanpur (U.P.)
Srijata Das, Senior Lecturer in Mathematics, SCERT, New Delhi
V.P. Singh, Reader (Retd.), DESM, NCERT, New Delhi
o
tt
MEMBER-COORDINATOR
Ashutosh K. Wazalwar, Professor, DESM, NCERT, New Delhi
no
2020-21
Acknowledgements
The Council gratefully acknowledges the valuable contributions of the following participants of the
Textbook Review Workshop – Ms. Nirupma Sahni, TGT, Mahavir Digambar Jain Sr. Sec. School,
Jaipur; Dr Roohi Fatima, TGT, Jamia Middle School, New Delhi; Ms. Deepti Mathur, TGT, Mother’s
International School, New Delhi; Shri K. Balaji, TGT, Kendriya Vidyalaya, Donimalai, Karnataka;
Shri Amit Bajaj, TGT, CRPF Public School, Delhi; Ms. Omlata Singh, TGT, Presentation Convent Sr.
Sec. School, Delhi; Shri Nagesh S. Mone, TGT, Dravid High School, Wai, Maharashtra; Shri Gorakh
Nath Sharma, PGT, Jawahar Navodaya Vidyalaya, Mesra, Ranchi, Jharkhand; Shri Ajay Kumar
Singh, TGT, Ramjas Sr. Sec. School, No.3, Delhi; Ms. Ragini Subramanian, TGT, SRDF Vivekananda
Vidyalaya, Chennai, Tamil Nadu; Shri Rajkumar Dhawan, PGT, Geeta Sr. Sec. School No.2, Delhi;
Dr Sanjay Mudgil, Lecturer, CIET, NCERT, New Delhi; Dr. Sushma Jaireth, Reader, DWS, NCERT,
New Delhi; Dr Mona Yadav, Lecturer, DWS, NCERT, New Delhi.
The Council acknowledges the comments/suggestions given by Dr Ram Avtar (Retd. Professor,
d
NCERT) Consultant, DESM, NCERT, New Delhi, Dr R.P. Maurya, Reader, DESM, NCERT,
he
New Delhi and Shri Sanjay Bolia, Senior Teacher, Vidya Bhawan Basic Secondary School, Udaipur,
pu T
Rajasthan for the improvement of the content.
is
re ER
The Council acknowledges the support and facilities provided by Vidya Bhawan Society and its
bl
staff, Udaipur, for conducting workshops of the development committee at Udaipur, and to the
Director, Centre for Science Education and Communication (CSEC), Delhi University for providing
be NC
library help.
The Council acknowledges the academic and administrative support of Professor Hukum Singh,
Head, DESM, NCERT, New Delhi.
The Council also acknowledges the efforts of S.M. Ikram, DTP Operator, Vidya Bhawan
©
Society Udaipur; Sajjad Haider Ansari, Rakesh Kumar and Neelam Walecha, DTP Operators,
Kanwar Singh, Copy Editor, NCERT; Abhimanu Mohanty, Proof Reader, NCERT; Deepak Kapoor,
Computer Station Incharge, DESM, NCERT for technical assistance, APC-office and the
o
Administrative Staff, DESM, NCERT; and the Publication Department of the NCERT.
tt
no
2020-21
xi
Contents
Foreword iii
Preface v
Chapter 1 Integers 1
Chapter 2 Fractions and Decimals 29
d
Chapter 6 The Triangle and its Properties 113
he
Chapter 7
pu T
Congruence of Triangles 133
is
re ER
Chapter 8 Comparing Quantities
bl 153
Answers 293
Brain-Teasers 311
2020-21
no
tt ©
o
be NC
2020-21
re ER
pu T
Isometric Dot Sheet
bl
is
he
d
Chapter 1
Integers
d
1.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
We have learnt about whole numbers and integers in Class VI.
is
re ER
We know that integers form a bigger collection of numbers
bl
which contains whole numbers and negative numbers. What
other differences do you find between whole numbers and
be NC
1.2 RECALL
o
We know how to represent integers on a number line. Some integers are marked on the
tt
Can you write these marked integers in ascending order? The ascending order of
these numbers is – 5, – 1, 3. Why did we choose – 5 as the smallest number?
Some points are marked with integers on the following number line. Write these integers
in descending order.
2020-21
2 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
d
he
On a number line when we
pu T
(i) add a positive integer, we move to the right.
is
re ER
(ii) add a negative integer, we move to the left.
bl
(iii) subtract a positive integer, we move to the left.
be NC
(i) When two positive integers are added we get a positive integer.
(ii) When two negative integers are added we get a positive integer.
(iii) When a positive integer and a negative integer are added, we always get a negative
o
integer.
tt
(v) For subtraction, we add the additive inverse of the integer that is being subtracted,
to the other integer.
(vi) (–10) + 3 = 10 – 3
(vii) 8 + (–7) – (– 4) = 8 + 7 – 4
Compare your answers with the answers given below:
(i) Correct. For example:
(a) 56 + 73 = 129 (b) 113 + 82 = 195 etc.
Construct five more examples in support of this statement.
(ii) Incorrect, since (– 6) + (– 7) = – 13, which is not a positive integer. The correct
statement is: When two negative integers are added we get a negative integer.
For example,
(a) (– 56) + (– 73) = – 129 (b) (– 113) + (– 82) = – 195, etc.
Construct five more examples on your own to verify this statement.
2020-21
INTEGERS 3
(iii) Incorrect, since – 9 + 16 = 7, which is not a negative integer. The correct statement is :
When one positive and one negative integers are added, we take their difference
and place the sign of the bigger integer. The bigger integer is decided by ignoring the
signs of both the integers. For example:
(a) (– 56) + (73) = 17 (b) (– 113) + 82 = – 31
(c) 16 + (– 23) = – 7 (d) 125 + (– 101) = 24
Construct five more examples for verifying this statement.
(iv) Correct. Some other examples of additive inverse are as given below:
d
–76 76
he
pu T
Thus, the additive inverse of any integer a is – a and additive inverse of (– a) is a.
is
re ER
(v) Correct. Subtraction is opposite of addition and therefore, we add the additive
inverse of the integer that is being subtracted, to the other integer. For example:
bl
(a) 56 – 73 = 56 + additive inverse of 73 = 56 + (–73) = –17
be NC
a – b = a + additive inverse of b = a + (– b)
tt
therefore, (–10) + 3 ≠ 10 – 3
(vii) Incorrect, since, 8 + (–7) – (– 4) = 8 + (–7) + 4 = 1 + 4 = 5
and 8 + 7 – 4 = 15 – 4 = 11
However, 8 + (–7) – (– 4) = 8 – 7 + 4
TRY THESE
We have done various patterns with numbers in our previous class.
Can you find a pattern for each of the following? If yes, complete them:
(a) 7, 3, – 1, – 5, _____, _____, _____.
(b) – 2, – 4, – 6, – 8, _____, _____, _____.
(c) 15, 10, 5, 0, _____, _____, _____.
(d) – 11, – 8, – 5, – 2, _____, _____, _____.
Make some more such patterns and ask your friends to complete them.
2020-21
4 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 1.1
1. Following number line shows the temperature in degree celsius (°C) at different places
on a particular day.
(a) Observe this number line and write the temperature of the places marked on it.
(b) What is the temperature difference between the hottest and the coldest places
among the above?
d
(c) What is the temperature difference between Lahulspiti and Srinagar?
he
pu T
(d) Can we say temperature of Srinagar and Shimla taken together is less than the
is
re ER
temperature at Shimla? Is it also less than the temperature at Srinagar?
bl
2. In a quiz, positive marks are given for correct answers and negative marks are given
be NC
for incorrect answers. If Jack’s scores in five successive rounds were 25, – 5, – 10,
15 and 10, what was his total at the end?
3. At Srinagar temperature was – 5°C on Monday and then it dropped
©
2020-21
INTEGERS 5
7. In a magic square each row, column and diagonal have the same sum. Check which
of the following is a magic square.
5 –1 –4 1 –10 0
–5 –2 7 –4 –3 –2
0 3 –3 –6 4 –7
(i) (ii)
8. Verify a – (– b) = a + b for the following values of a and b.
(i) a = 21, b = 18 (ii) a = 118, b = 125
(iii) a = 75, b = 84 (iv) a = 28, b = 11
9. Use the sign of >, < or = in the box to make the statements true.
d
(a) (– 8) + (– 4) (–8) – (– 4)
he
(b) (– 3) + 7 – (19) pu T15 – 8 + (– 9)
is
re ER
(c) 23 – 41 + 11 23 – 41 – 11
(d) 39 + (– 24) – (15)
bl36 + (– 52) – (– 36)
be NC
(i) He jumps 3 steps down and then jumps back 2 steps up.
In how many jumps will he reach the water level?
(ii) After drinking water, he wants to go back. For this, he
o
2020-21
6 MATHEMATICS
Statement Observation
(i) 17 + 23 = 40 Result is an integer
(ii) (–10) + 3 = _____ ______________
(iii) (– 75) + 18 = _____ ______________
(iv) 19 + (– 25) = – 6 Result is an integer
(v) 27 + (– 27) = _____ ______________
(vi) (– 20) + 0 = _____ ______________
(vii) (– 35) + (– 10) = _____ ______________
d
he
What do you observe? Is the sum of two integers always an integer?
pu T
Did you find a pair of integers whose sum is not an integer?
is
re ER
Since addition of integers gives integers, we say integers are closed under addition.
bl
In general, for any two integers a and b, a + b is an integer.
be NC
Statement Observation
tt
What do you observe? Is there any pair of integers whose difference is not an integer?
Can we say integers are closed under subtraction? Yes, we can see that integers are
closed under subtraction.
Thus, if a and b are two integers then a – b is also an intger. Do the whole numbers
satisfy this property?
2020-21
INTEGERS 7
d
Try this with five other pairs of integers. Do you find any pair of integers for which the
he
sums are different when the order is changed? Certainly not. We say that addition is
pu T
commutative for integers.
is
re ER
In general, for any two integers a and b, we can say
bl
a+b=b+a
be NC
Is 5 – (–3) the same as (–3) –5? No, because 5 – ( –3) = 5 + 3 = 8, and (–3) – 5
= – 3 – 5 = – 8.
o
2020-21
8 MATHEMATICS
d
he
1.3.5 Additive Identity
pu T
When we add zero to any whole number, we get the same whole number. Zero is an
is
re ER
additive identity for whole numbers. Is it an additive identity again for integers also?
bl
Observe the following and fill in the blanks:
be NC
(i) (– 8) + 0 = – 8 (ii) 0 + (– 8) = – 8
(iii) (–23) + 0 = _____ (iv) 0 + (–37) = –37
(v) 0 + (–59) = _____ (vi) 0 + _____ = – 43
©
a+0=a=0+a
TRY THESE
1. Write a pair of integers whose sum gives
(a) a negative integer (b) zero
(c) an integer smaller than both the integers. (d) an integer smaller than only one of the integers.
(e) an integer greater than both the integers.
2. Write a pair of integers whose difference gives
(a) a negative integer. (b) zero.
(c) an integer smaller than both the integers. (d) an integer greater than only one of the integers.
(e) an integer greater than both the integers.
2020-21
INTEGERS 9
EXERCISE 1.2
d
he
1. Write down a pair of integers whose:
pu T
is
re ER
(a) sum is –7 (b) difference is –10
bl (c) sum is 0
2. (a) Write a pair of negative integers whose difference gives 8.
be NC
(b) Write a negative integer and a positive integer whose sum is –5.
(c) Write a negative integer and a positive integer whose difference is –3.
3. In a quiz, team A scored – 40, 10, 0 and team B scored 10, 0, – 40 in three successive
©
rounds. Which team scored more? Can we say that we can add integers in
any order?
o
2020-21
10 MATHEMATICS
We have from the following number line, (–5) + (–5) + (–5) = –15
TRY THESE
Find:
4 × (– 8),
8 × (–2), –20 –15 –10 –5 0
3 × (–7),
10 × (–1) But we can also write
using number line. (–5) + (–5) + (–5) = 3 × (–5)
Therefore, 3 × (–5) = –15
Similarly (– 4) + (– 4) + (– 4) + (– 4) + (– 4) = 5 × (– 4) = –20
d
–16
he
–20 –12 –8 –4 0
pu T
is
re ER
And (–3) + (–3) + (–3) + (–3) = __________ = __________
bl
Also, (–7) + (–7) + (–7) = __________ = __________
be NC
Let us see how to find the product of a positive integer and a negative integer without
using number line.
Let us find 3 × (–5) in a different way. First find 3 × 5 and then put minus sign (–)
©
before the product obtained. You get –15. That is we find – (3 × 5) to get –15.
Similarly, 5 × (– 4) = – (5×4) = – 20.
Find in a similar way,
o
tt
2020-21
INTEGERS 11
–2 × 5 = –5 – 5 = –10
–3 × 5 = –10 – 5 = –15
We already have 3 × (–5) = –15
So we get (–3) × 5 = –15 = 3 × (–5)
Using such patterns, we also get (–5) × 4 = –20 = 5 × (– 4)
Using patterns, find (– 4) × 8, (–3) × 7, (– 6) × 5 and (– 2) × 9
Check whether, (– 4) × 8 = 4 × (– 8), (– 3) × 7 = 3 × (–7), (– 6) × 5 = 6 × (– 5)
and (– 2) × 9 = 2 × (– 9)
Using this we get, (–33) × 5 = 33 × (–5) = –165
We thus find that while multiplying a positive integer and a negative integer, we
d
multiply them as whole numbers and put a minus sign (–) before the product. We
he
thus get a negative integer. pu T
is
re ER
TRY THESE bl
1. Find: (a) 15 × (–16) (b) 21 × (–32)
be NC
a × (– b) = (– a) × b = – (a × b)
no
2020-21
12 MATHEMATICS
d
he
From these patterns we observe that,
pu T
(–3) × (–1) = 3 = 3 × 1
is
re ER
(–3) × (–2) = 6 = 3 × 2
bl
(–3) × (–3) = 9 = 3 × 3
be NC
and (– 4) × (–1) = 4 = 4 × 1
So, (– 4) × (–2) = 4 × 2 = _____
(– 4) × (–3) = _____ = _____
©
So observing these products we can say that the product of two negative integers is
a positive integer. We multiply the two negative integers as whole numbers and put
o
Similarly (–15) × (– 6) = + 90 = 90
In general, for any two positive integers a and b,
(– a) × (– b) = a × b
Game 1
(i) Take a board marked from –104 to 104 as shown in the figure.
(ii) Take a bag containing two blue and two red dice. Number of dots on the blue dice
indicate positive integers and number of dots on the red dice indicate negative integers.
(iii) Every player will place his/her counter at zero.
(iv) Each player will take out two dice at a time from the bag and throw them.
2020-21
INTEGERS 13
d
he
–6 –7 –8 –9 –10 –11 –12
pu T –13 –14 –15 –16
–27 –26 –25 –24 –23 –22 –21 –20 –19 –18 –17
is
re ER
–28 –29 –30 –31 –32 –33 –34
bl –35 –36 –37 –38
– 49 – 48 – 47 – 46 – 45 – 44 – 43 – 42 – 41 – 40 –39
be NC
–72 –73 –74 –75 –76 –77 –78 –79 –80 –81 –82
– 93 – 92 – 91 – 90 – 89 – 88 – 87 – 86 – 85 – 84 – 83
– 94 – 95 – 96 – 97 – 98 – 99 – 100 –101 –102 –103 –104
o
tt
(v) After every throw, the player has to multiply the numbers marked on the dice.
no
(vi) If the product is a positive integer then the player will move his counter towards
104; if the product is a negative integer then the player will move his counter
towards –104.
(vii) The player who reaches either -104 or 104 first is the winner.
2020-21
14 MATHEMATICS
d
(b) the product of three negative integers the resultant products:
he
is a negative integer.
pu T (–1) × (–1) = +1
(c) product of four negative integers is (–1) × (–1) × (–1) = –1
is
re ER
a positive integer.
bl (–1) × (–1) × (–1) × (–1) = +1
What is the product of five negative integers in
(–1) × (–1) × (–1) × (–1) × (–1) = –1
be NC
(d)?
So what will be the product of six negative This means that if the integer
integers? (–1) is multiplied even number of times,
We further see that in (a) and (c) above, the product is +1 and if the integer (–1)
©
the number of negative integers that are is multiplied odd number of times, the
multiplied are even [two and four respectively] product is –1. You can check this by
and the product obtained in (a) and (c) are making pairs of (–1) in the statement.
o
positive integers. The number of negative This is useful in working out products of
tt
negative integers.
We find that if the number of negative integers in a product is even, then the
product is a positive integer; if the number of negative integers in a product is odd,
then the product is a negative integer.
Justify it by taking five more examples of each kind.
2020-21
INTEGERS 15
Statement Inference
(–20) × (–5) = 100 Product is an integer
(–15) × 17 = – 255 Product is an integer
d
(–30) × 12 = _____
he
(–15) × (–23) = _____pu T
is
re ER
(–14) × (–13) = _____
12 × (–30) = _____
bl
be NC
What do you observe? Can you find a pair of integers whose product is not an integer?
No. This gives us an idea that the product of two integers is again an integer. So we can
say that integers are closed under multiplication.
©
In general,
a × b is an integer, for all integers a and b.
Find the product of five more pairs of integers and verify the above statement.
o
tt
We know that multiplication is commutative for whole numbers. Can we say, multiplication
is also commutative for integers?
Observe the following table and complete it:
Statement 1 Statement 2 Inference
3 × (– 4) = –12 (– 4) × 3 = –12 3 × (– 4) = (– 4) × 3
(–30) × 12 = _____ 12 × (–30) = _____
(–15) × (–10) = 150 (–10) × (–15) = 150
(–35) × (–12) = _____ (–12) × (–35) =
(–17) × 0 = _____
__________ = _____ (–1) × (–15) =
2020-21
16 MATHEMATICS
d
0 × (– 6) = _____
he
This shows that the product of a negative integer and zero is zero.
pu T
In general, for any integer a,
is
re ER
bl a×0=0×a=0
be NC
1 × (– 6) = _____ 7 × 1 = _____
no
2020-21
INTEGERS 17
d
7 × [(– 6) × 4] = 7 × __________ = __________
he
Is [7 × (– 6)] × 4 = 7 × [(– 6) × 4]? pu T
is
re ER
Does the grouping of integers affect the product of integers? No.
In general, for any three integers a, b and c
bl
be NC
(a × b) × c = a × (b × c)
Take any five values for a, b and c each and verify this property.
Thus, like whole numbers, the product of three integers does not depend upon
©
the grouping of integers and this is called the associative property for multiplication
of integers.
o
We know
no
2020-21
18 MATHEMATICS
Can we say that the distributivity of multiplication over addition is true for integers
also? Yes.
In general, for any integers a, b and c,
a × (b + c) = a × b + a × c
Take atleast five different values for each of a, b and c and verify the above Distributive
property.
TRY THESE
(i) Is 10 × [(6 + (–2)] = 10 × 6 + 10 × (–2)?
(ii) Is (–15) × [(–7) + (–1)] = (–15) × (–7) + (–15) × (–1)?
d
Now consider the following:
he
Can we say 4 × (3 – 8) = 4 × 3 – 4 × 8?
Let us check:
pu T
is
re ER
4 × (3 – 8) = 4 × (–5) = –20
bl
4 × 3 – 4 × 8 = 12 – 32 = –20
be NC
So, 4 × (3 – 8) = 4 × 3 – 4 × 8.
Look at the following:
( –5) × [( – 4) – ( – 6)] = ( –5) × 2 = –10
©
a × (b – c) = a × b – a × c
Take atleast five different values for each of a, b and c and verify this property.
TRY THESE
(i) Is 10 × (6 – (–2)] = 10 × 6 – 10 × (–2)?
(ii) Is (–15) × [(–7) – (–1)] = (–15) × (–7) – (–15) × (–1)?
2020-21
INTEGERS 19
d
16 × 12 = 16 × (10 + 2) = 16 × 10 + 16 × 2 = 160 + 32 = 192
he
(iii) (–23) × 48 = (–23) × [50 – 2] = (–23) × 50 – (–23) × 2 = (–1150) – (– 46)
pu T
= –1104
is
re ER
(iv)
bl
(–35) × (–98) = (–35) × [(–100) + 2] = (–35) × (–100) + (–35) × 2
be NC
TRY THESE
tt
no
Find (– 49) × 18; (–25) × (–31); 70 × (–19) + (–1) × 70 using distributive property.
SOLUTION
(i) (–18) × (–10) × 9 = [(–18) × (–10)] × 9 = 180 × 9 = 1620
(ii) (–20) × (–2) × (–5) × 7 = – 20 × (–2 × –5) × 7 = [–20 × 10] × 7 = – 1400
(iii) (–1) × (–5) × (– 4) × (– 6) = [(–1) × (–5)] × [(– 4) × (– 6)] = 5 × 24 = 120
2020-21
20 MATHEMATICS
d
he
So, marks given for 6 = (15 – 9) incorrect answers = (–2) × 6 = –12
pu T
Therefore, Gurpreet’s total score = 36 + ( –12) = 24
is
re ER
(ii) Marks given for one correct answer = 4
bl
So, marks given for 5 correct answers = 4 × 5 = 20
be NC
(i) An elevator descends into a mine shaft at the rate of 5 metre per minute. What will
be its position after one hour?
no
(ii) If it begins to descend from 15 m above the ground, what will be its position after 45
minutes?
SOLUTION
(i) Since the elevator is going down, so the distance covered by it will be represented
by a negative integer.
Change in position of the elevator in one minute = – 5 m
Position of the elevator after 60 minutes = (–5) × 60 = – 300 m, i.e., 300 m below
down from the starting position of elevator.
(ii) Change in position of the elevator in 45 minutes = (–5) × 45 = –225 m, i.e., 225 m
below ground level.
So, the final position of the elevator = –225 + 15 = –210 m, i.e., 210 m below
ground level.
2020-21
INTEGERS 21
EXERCISE 1.3
1. Find each of the following products:
(a) 3 × (–1) (b) (–1) × 225
(c) (–21) × (–30) (d) (–316) × (–1)
(e) (–15) × 0 × (–18) (f) (–12) × (–11) × (10)
(g) 9 × (–3) × (– 6) (h) (–18) × (–5) × (– 4)
(i) (–1) × (–2) × (–3) × 4 (j) (–3) × (–6) × (–2) × (–1)
2. Verify the following:
(a) 18 × [7 + (–3)] = [18 × 7] + [18 × (–3)]
(b) (–21) × [(– 4) + (– 6)] = [(–21) × (– 4)] + [(–21) × (– 6)]
d
he
3. (i) For any integer a, what is (–1) × a equal to?
pu T
(ii) Determine the integer whose product with (–1) is
is
re ER
(a) –22 (b) 37
bl (c) 0
4. Starting from (–1) × 5, write various products showing some pattern to show
be NC
(–1) × (–1) = 1.
5. Find the product, using suitable properties:
(a) 26 × (– 48) + (– 48) × (–36) (b) 8 × 53 × (–125)
©
6. A certain freezing process requires that room temperature be lowered from 40°C at
no
the rate of 5°C every hour. What will be the room temperature 10 hours after the
process begins?
7. In a class test containing 10 questions, 5 marks are awarded for every correct answer
and (–2) marks are awarded for every incorrect answer and 0 for questions not
attempted.
(i) Mohan gets four correct and six incorrect answers. What is his score?
(ii) Reshma gets five correct answers and five incorrect answers, what is her score?
(iii) Heena gets two correct and five incorrect answers out of seven questions she
attempts. What is her score?
8. A cement company earns a profit of ` 8 per bag of white cement sold and a loss of
` 5 per bag of grey cement sold.
(a) The company sells 3,000 bags of white cement and 5,000 bags of grey cement
in a month. What is its profit or loss?
2020-21
22 MATHEMATICS
(b) What is the number of white cement bags it must sell to have neither profit
nor loss, if the number of grey bags sold is 6,400 bags.
9. Replace the blank with an integer to make it a true statement.
(a) (–3) × _____ = 27 (b) 5 × _____ = –35
(c) _____ × (– 8) = –56 (d) _____ × (–12) = 132
d
Similarly, 4 × 3 = 12 gives 12 ÷ 4 = 3 and 12 ÷ 3 = 4
he
We can say for each multiplication statement of whole numbers there are two
pu T
division statements.
is
re ER
Can you write multiplication statement and its corresponding divison statements
bl
for integers?
be NC
_____________ , _____________
(– 8) × 4 = ____
_____________ , _____________
5 × (– 9) = _____
_____________ , _____________
(–10) × (–5) =
2020-21
INTEGERS 23
TRY THESE
d
Find: (a) 125 ÷ (–25) (b) 80 ÷ (–5) (c) 64 ÷ (–16)
he
l Lastly, we observe that
pu T
is
re ER
(–12) ÷ (– 6) = 2; (–20) ÷ (– 4) = 5; (–32) ÷ (– 8) = 4; (– 45) ÷ (–9) = 5
bl
So, we can say that when we divide a negative integer by a negative integer, we first
be NC
divide them as whole numbers and then put a positive sign (+).
In general, for any two positive integers a and b
(– a) ÷ (– b) = a ÷ b where b ≠ 0
©
TRY THESE
o
(– 8) ÷ (– 4) = 2 Result is an integer –8
(– 8) ÷ 3 = ________________
3
–4
(– 4) ÷ (– 8) = Result is not an integer 3 ÷ (– 8) = 3 ________________
–8 –8
Justify it by taking five more examples of your own.
l We know that division is not commutative for whole numbers. Let us check it for
integers also.
2020-21
24 MATHEMATICS
d
he
(– 8) ÷ 1 = (– 8) pu T (–11) ÷ 1 = –11 (–13) ÷ 1 = –13
(–25) ÷ 1 = ____ (–37) ÷ 1 = ____ (– 48) ÷ 1 = ____
is
re ER
This shows that negative integer divided by 1 gives the same negative integer.
bl
So, any integer divided by 1 gives the same integer.
be NC
l What happens when we divide any integer by (–1)? Complete the following table
(– 8) ÷ (–1) = 8 11 ÷ (–1) = –11 13 ÷ (–1) = ____
o
We can say that if any integer is divided by (–1) it does not give the same integer.
EXAMPLE 6 In a test (+5) marks are given for every correct answer and (–2) marks
are given for every incorrect answer. (i) Radhika answered all the questions
and scored 30 marks though she got 10 correct answers. (ii) Jay also
2020-21
INTEGERS 25
answered all the questions and scored (–12) marks though he got 4
correct answers. How many incorrect answers had they attempted?
SOLUTION
(i) Marks given for one correct answer = 5
So, marks given for 10 correct answers = 5 × 10 = 50
Radhika’s score = 30
Marks obtained for incorrect answers = 30 – 50 = – 20
Marks given for one incorrect answer = (–2)
Therefore, number of incorrect answers = (–20) ÷ (–2) = 10
(ii) Marks given for 4 correct answers = 5 × 4 = 20
d
he
Jay’s score = –12
pu T
Marks obtained for incorrect answers = –12 – 20 = – 32
is
re ER
Marks given for one incorrect answer = (–2)
bl
Therefore number of incorrect answers = (–32) ÷ (–2) = 16
be NC
EXAMPLE 7 A shopkeeper earns a profit of ` 1 by selling one pen and incurs a loss
of 40 paise per pencil while selling pencils of her old stock.
©
(i) In a particular month she incurs a loss of ` 5. In this period, she sold 45 pens. How
many pencils did she sell in this period?
(ii) In the next month she earns neither profit nor loss. If she sold 70 pens, how many
o
SOLUTION
no
2020-21
26 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 1.4
1. Evaluate each of the following:
(a) (–30) ÷ 10 (b) 50 ÷ (–5) (c) (–36) ÷ (–9)
(d) (– 49) ÷ (49) (e) 13 ÷ [(–2) + 1] (f ) 0 ÷ (–12)
d
he
(g) (–31) ÷ [(–30) + (–1)]
(h) [(–36) ÷ 12] ÷ 3
pu T (i) [(– 6) + 5)] ÷ [(–2) + 1]
is
re ER
2. Verify that a ÷ (b + c) ≠ (a ÷ b) + (a ÷ c) for each of the following values of a, b and c.
bl
(a) a = 12, b = – 4, c = 2 (b) a = (–10), b = 1, c = 1
be NC
4. Write five pairs of integers (a, b) such that a ÷ b = –3. One such pair is (6, –2)
no
2020-21
INTEGERS 27
d
a and b.
he
(c) Addition is associative for integers, i.e., (a + b) + c = a + (b + c) for all integers
pu T
is
re ER
a, b and c.
bl
(d) Integer 0 is the identity under addition. That is, a + 0 = 0 + a = a for every
be NC
integer a.
4. We studied, how integers could be multiplied, and found that product of a positive
and a negative integer is a negative integer, whereas the product of two negative
©
2020-21
28 MATHEMATICS
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
no
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 29
Chapter 2
Fractions and
Decimals
d
2.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
You have learnt fractions and decimals in earlier classes. The study of fractions included
is
re ER
proper, improper and mixed fractions as well as their addition and subtraction. We also
bl
studied comparison of fractions, equivalent fractions, representation of fractions on the
number line and ordering of fractions.
be NC
Our study of decimals included, their comparison, their representation on the number
line and their addition and subtraction.
©
7
tt
2020-21
30 MATHEMATICS
2 4
EXAMPLE 2 Ramesh solved part of an exercise while Seema solved of it. Who
7 5
solved lesser part?
SOLUTION In order to find who solved lesser part of the exercise, let us compare
2 4
and .
7 5
2 10 4 28
Converting them to like fractions we have, = , = .
7 35 5 35
10 28
Since10 < 28 , so < .
35 35
d
he
pu T 2 4
Thus, < .
7 5
is
re ER
Ramesh solved lesser part than Seema.
bl
be NC
1 3
EXAMPLE 3 Sameera purchased 3 kg apples and 4 kg oranges. What is the
2 4
total weight of fruits purchased by her?
©
1 3
SOLUTION The total weight of the fruits = 3 + 4 kg
2 4
o
tt
7 19 14 19
= + kg = + kg
2 4 4 4
no
33 1
= kg = 8 kg
4 4
2 4
EXAMPLE 4 Suman studies for 5 hours daily. She devotes 2 hours of her time
3 5
for Science and Mathematics. How much time does she devote for
other subjects?
2 17
SOLUTION Total time of Suman’s study = 5 h= h
3 3
4 14
Time devoted by her for Science and Mathematics = 2 = h
5 5
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 31
17 14
Thus, time devoted by her for other subjects = − h
3 5
17 × 5 14 × 3 85 – 42
= – h = h
15 15 15
43 13
= h= 2 h
15 15
EXERCISE 2.1
1. Solve:
3 7 3 2 9 4
d
(i) 2 − (ii) 4 + (iii) + (iv) −
5 8 5 7 11 15
he
(v)
7 2 3
+ +
2
(vi) 2 + 3
1
pu T 1
(vii) 8 − 3
5
is
re ER
10 5 2 3 2 bl 2 8
2. Arrange the following in descending order:
be NC
2 2 8 1 3 7
(i) , , (ii) , , .
9 3 21 5 7 10
3. In a “magic square”, the sum of the numbers in each row, in each column and along
©
4 9 2
11 11 11
o
3 5 7 4 9 2 15
tt
8 1 6
11 11 11
1 2
4. A rectangular sheet of paper is 12 cm long and 10 cm wide. 5 3
2 3 cm 3 cm
2 3 5
Find its perimeter. 2 cm
5. Find the perimeters of (i) ∆ ABE (ii) the rectangle BCDE in this 4
figure. Whose perimeter is greater? 7
cm
3 6
6. Salil wants to put a picture in a frame. The picture is 7 cm wide.
5
3
To fit in the frame the picture cannot be more than 7 cm wide. How much should
10
the picture be trimmed?
2020-21
32 MATHEMATICS
3
7. Ritu ate part of an apple and the remaining apple was eaten by her brother Somu.
5
How much part of the apple did Somu eat? Who had the larger share? By how
much?
7
8. Michael finished colouring a picture in hour. Vaibhav finished colouring the same
12
3
picture in hour. Who worked longer? By what fraction was it longer?
4
d
You know how to find the area of a rectangle. It is equal to length × breadth. If the length
he
and breadth of a rectangle are 7 cm and 4 cm respectively, then what will be its area? Its
pu T
area would be 7 × 4 = 28 cm2.
is
re ER
bl 1
What will be the area of the rectangle if its length and breadth are 7 cm and
2
be NC
1 1 1 15 7 15
3 cm respectively? You will say it will be 7 × 3 = × cm2. The numbers
2 2 2 2 2 2
©
7
and are fractions. To calculate the area of the given rectangle, we need to know how to
2
multiply fractions. We shall learn that now.
o
tt
1
Observe the pictures at the left (Fig 2.1). Each shaded part ispart of
4
a circle. How much will the two shaded parts represent together? They
1 1 1
+ = 2× .
will represent
4 4 4
Fig 2.1 Combining the two shaded parts, we get Fig 2.2 . What part of a circle does the
2
shaded part in Fig 2.2 represent? It represents part of a circle .
4
Fig 2.2
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 33
The shaded portions in Fig 2.1 taken together are the same as the shaded portion in
Fig 2.2, i.e., we get Fig 2.3.
Fig 2.3
1 2
or 2× = .
4 4
Can you now tell what this picture will represent? (Fig 2.4)
d
he
=
pu T
is
re ER
bl Fig 2.4
And this? (Fig 2.5)
be NC
=
©
Fig 2.5
o
1
tt
1 1 1 1 3
We have 3× = + + =
2 2 2 2 2
1 1 1 1+1+1 3×1 3
We also have + + = = =
2 2 2 2 2 2
1 3×1 3
So 3× = =
2 2 2
2 2 ×5
Similarly ×5 = =?
3 3
2 3
Can you tell 3× =? 4× =?
7 5
1 2 2 3 3
The fractions that we considered till now, i.e., , , ,and were proper fractions.
2 3 7 5 5
2020-21
34 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
2 9 1 13
1. Find: (a) ×3 (b) ×6 (c) 3 × (d) ×6
d
7 7 8 11
he
If the product is an improper fraction express it as a mixed fraction.
pu T
is
re ER
2 4
2. Represent pictorially :
bl 2× =
5 5
be NC
9 Similarly, 2× 4 = 2× =?
5 5
tt
no
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 35
d
Thus, of 3 = × 3 = .
2 2 2
he
So we see that ‘of’ represents multiplication.
pu T
is
re ER
1
Farida has 20 marbles. Reshma hasth of the number of marbles what
bl
5
Farida has. How many marbles Reshma has? As, ‘of ’ indicates multiplication,
be NC
1
so, Reshma has × 20 = 4 marbles.
5
©
1 1 16
Similarly, we have of 16 is ×16 = = 8.
2 2 2
o
TRY THESE
tt
1 1 2
Can you tell, what is (i) of 10?, (ii) of 16?, (iii) of 25?
no
2 4 5
1
EXAMPLE 5 In a class of 40 students of the total number of studetns like to study
5
2
English, of the total number like to study Mathematics and the remaining
5
students like to study Science.
(i) How many students like to study English?
(ii) How many students like to study Mathematics?
(iii) What fraction of the total number of students like to study Science?
SOLUTION Total number of students in the class = 40.
1
(i) Of these of the total number of students like to study English.
5
2020-21
36 MATHEMATICS
1 1
Thus, the number of students who like to study English = of 40 = × 40 = 8.
5 5
(ii) Try yourself.
(iii) The number of students who like English and Mathematics = 8 + 16 = 24. Thus, the
number of students who like Science = 40 – 24 = 16.
EXERCISE 2.2
1. Which of the drawings (a) to (d) show :
1 1 2 1
d
(i) 2 × (ii) 2 × (iii) 3 × (iv) 3 ×
he
5 2 3 4
pu T
is
re ER
(a) (b)
bl
be NC
(c) (d)
©
2. Some pictures (a) to (c) are given below. Tell which of them show:
1 3 1 2 3 1
o
5 5 3 3 4 4
no
(a) (b)
(c)
3. Multiply and reduce to lowest form and convert into a mixed fraction:
3 1 6 2 2
(i) 7 × (ii) 4 × (iii) 2 × (iv) 5 × (v) ×4
5 3 7 9 3
5 4 4 1 3
(vi) ×6 (vii) 11× (viii) 20 × (ix) 13 × (x) 15 ×
2 7 5 3 5
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 37
1 2
4. Shade: (i) of the circles in box (a) (ii) of the triangles in box (b)
2 3
3
(iii) of the squares in box (c).
5
d
he
1 2
(a) of (i) 24 (ii) 46 (b) pu Tof (i) 18 (ii) 27
2 3
is
re ER
3 4 bl
(c) of (i) 16 (ii) 36 (d) of (i) 20 (ii) 35
4 5
be NC
1 1 2
(d) 4 × 6 (e) 3 ×6 (f) 3 ×8
3 4 5
o
3 2
tt
1 5 5 2
7. Find: (a) of (i) 2 (ii) 4 (b) of (i) 3 (ii) 9
2 4 9 8 6 3
no
8. Vidya and Pratap went for a picnic. Their mother gave them a water bottle that
2
contained 5 litres of water. Vidya consumed of the water. Pratap consumed the
5
remaining water.
(i) How much water did Vidya drink?
(ii) What fraction of the total quantity of water did Pratap drink?
2020-21
38 MATHEMATICS
1 9
folding the part once. What will one of the pieces represent? It will represent of or
2 4
1 9
× .
2 4
1 9
Let us now see how to find the product of two fractions like × .
2 4
1 1
To do this we first learn to find the products like × .
2 3
1
(a) How do we find of a whole? We divide the whole in three equal parts. Each of
3
d
he
1
Fig 2.8 the three parts represents
pu T of the whole. Take one part of these three parts, and
3
is
re ER
shade it as shown in Fig 2.8.
bl
A
1 1
(b) How will you find of this shaded part? Divide this one-third ( ) shaded part into
be NC
2 3
1 1 1 1
two equal parts. Each of these two parts represents of i.e., × (Fig 2.9).
2 3 2 3
©
Fig 2.9 1 1
Take out 1 part of these two and name it ‘A’. ‘A’ represents × .
2 3
o
1
tt
(c) What fraction is ‘A’ of the whole? For this, divide each of the remaining parts also
3
no
in two equal parts. How many such equal parts do you have now?
There are six such equal parts. ‘A’ is one of these parts.
1 1 1 1
So, ‘A’ is of the whole. Thus, × = .
6 2 3 6
1
How did we decide that ‘A’ was of the whole? The whole was divided in 6 = 2 × 3
6
parts and 1 = 1 × 1 part was taken out of it.
1 1 1 1×1
Thus, × = =
2 3 6 2×3
1 1 1×1
or × =
2 3 2×3
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 39
1 1
The value of × can be found in a similar way. Divide the whole into two equal
3 2
parts and then divide one of these parts in three equal parts. Take one of these parts. This
d
3 4 4 3 2 5 5 2
he
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
pu T
× = × ; × = ×
3 4 4 3 2 5 5 2
is
re ER
TRY THESE
bl
be NC
1 1 1 1
(iii) × = = (iv) × = =
o
7 2 7 5
tt
1
EXAMPLE 6 Sushant reads
no
2020-21
40 MATHEMATICS
5 1× 5 1 5 1× 5 5
Also, = . Thus, × = = .
6 2×3 2 3 2×3 6
This is also shown by the figures drawn below. Each of these five equal shapes
(Fig 2.10) are parts of five similar circles. Take one such shape. To obtain this shape
we first divide a circle in three equal parts. Further divide each of these three parts in
two equal parts. One part out of it is the shape we considered. What will it represent?
1 1 1 1 5
It will represent × = . The total of such parts would be 5 × = .
2 3 6 6 6
d
he
pu T Fig 2.10
is
re ER
TRY THESE bl 3 1 3 ×1 3
Similarly × = = .
5 7 5× 7 35
be NC
1 4 2 1
Find: × ; × 2 7 2 7 2 × 7 14
3 5 3 5 We can thus find × as × = = .
3 5 3 5 3 × 5 15
©
Product of Numerators
So, we find that we multiply two fractions as .
Product of Denominators
Value of the Products
o
tt
TRY THESE You have seen that the product of two whole numbers is bigger than each of
the two whole numbers. For example, 3 × 4 = 12 and 12 > 4, 12 > 3. What
no
2 4 8 8 2 8 4
× = < , < Product is less than each of the fractions
3 5 15 15 3 15 5
1 2
× = --------- --------,-------- --------------------------------------
5 7
3
× = --------,-------- --------------------------------------
5 8
2 4 8
× = --------,-------- --------------------------------------
9 45
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 41
You will find that when two proper fractions are multiplied, the product is less
than each of the fractions. Or, we say the value of the product of two proper fractions
is smaller than each of the two fractions.
Check this by constructing five more examples.
Let us now multiply two improper fractions.
7 5 35 35 7 35 5
× = > , > Product is greater than each of the fractions
3 2 6 6 3 6 2
6 24
× = --------,-------- ----------------------------------------
5 3 15
9 7 63
× = --------,-------- ----------------------------------------
d
2 8
he
3 8 24 pu T
× = --------,-------- ----------------------------------------
is
7 14
re ER
bl
We find that the product of two improper fractions is greater than each of the
be NC
two fractions.
Or, the value of the product of two improper fractions is more than each of the
two fractions.
©
Construct five more examples for yourself and verify the above statement.
2 7
Let us now multiply a proper and an improper fraction, say and .
3 5
o
tt
2 7 14 14 7 14 2
We have × = . Here, < and >
3 5 15 15 5 15 3
no
The product obtained is less than the improper fraction and greater than the proper fraction
involved in the multiplication.
6 2 8 4
Check it for × , × .
5 8 3 5
EXERCISE 2.3
1. Find:
1 1 3 4
(i) of (a) (b) (c)
4 4 5 3
1 2 6 3
(ii) of (a) (b) (c)
7 9 5 10
2020-21
42 MATHEMATICS
2 2 2 7 3 6 9 3
(i) ×2 (ii) × (iii) × (iv) ×
3 3 7 9 8 4 5 5
1 15 11 3 4 12
(v) × (vi) × (vii) ×
3 8 2 10 5 7
3. Multiply the following fractions:
2 1 2 7 3 1 5 3
(i) ×5 (ii) 6 × (iii) ×5 (iv) ×2
5 4 5 9 2 3 6 7
2 4 3 4 3
(v) 3 × (vi) 2 × 3 (vii) 3 ×
5 7 5 7 5
d
he
4. Which is greater:
2 3
pu T
3 5 1 6 2 3
is
re ER
(i) of or of (ii) of or of
7 4 5bl 8 2 7 3 7
5. Saili plants 4 saplings, in a row, in her garden. The distance between two adjacent
be NC
3
saplings is m. Find the distance between the first and the last sapling.
4
©
3
6. Lipika reads a book for 1 hours everyday. She reads the entire book in 6 days.
4
How many hours in all were required by her to read the book?
o
tt
3
7. A car runs 16 km using 1 litre of petrol. How much distance will it cover using 2
4
no
litres of petrol.
2 10
8. (a) (i) Provide the number in the box , such that × = .
3 30
(ii) The simplest form of the number obtained in is _____.
3 24
(b) (i) Provide the number in the box , such that × = .
5 75
(ii) The simplest form of the number obtained in is _____.
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 43
3
John cuts another strip of length 6 cm into smaller strips of length cm each. How
2
3
many strips will he get now? He will get 6 ÷ strips.
2
15 3
A paper strip of length cm can be cut into smaller strips of length cm each to give
2 2
15 3
÷ pieces.
2 2
So, we are required to divide a whole number by a fraction or a fraction by another
fraction. Let us see how to do that.
d
2.4.1 Division of Whole Number by a Fraction
he
1 pu T
Let us find 1÷ .
2
is
re ER
We divide a whole into a number of equal parts such that each part is half of the whole.
bl
1 1
be NC
The number of such half ( ) parts would be 1÷ . Observe the figure (Fig 2.11). How
2 2
many half parts do you see?
There are two half parts.
©
1 1
1 2 1 2
So, 1÷ = 2. Also, 1× = 1 × 2 = 2. Thus, 1 ÷ = 1 × 2 2
2 1 2 1
o
1 1
tt
Similarly, 3 ÷ = number of parts obtained when each of the 3 whole, are divided Fig 2.11
4 4
no
1
into equal parts = 12 (From Fig 2.12)
4
1 1 1 1 1 1
4 4 4 4 4 4
1 1 1 1 1 1
4 4 4 4 4 4
Fig 2.12
4 1 4
Observe also that, 3× = 3 × 4 = 12. Thus, 3 ÷ = 3 × = 12.
1 4 1
1 2
Find in a similar way, 3 ÷ and 3 × .
2 1
2020-21
44 MATHEMATICS
Reciprocal of a fraction
2
The number can be obtained by interchanging the numerator and denominator of
1
1 1 3 1
or by inverting . Similarly, is obtained by inverting .
2 2 1 3
Let us first see about the inverting of such numbers.
Observe these products and fill in the blanks :
1 5 4
7× = 1 × = ---------
7 4 5
1 2
× 9 = ------ × ------- = 1
9 7
2 3 2×3 6 5
× = ------ × = 1
d
= =1
3 2 3× 2 6 9
he
pu T
Multiply five more such pairs.
is
re ER
The non-zero numbers whose product with each other is 1, are called the
bl 5 9 9 5
reciprocals of each other. So reciprocal of is and the reciprocal of is . What
be NC
9 5 5 9
1 2
is the receiprocal of ? ?
9 7
©
2 3
You will see that the reciprocal of is obtained by inverting it. You get .
3 2
o
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 45
Thus, to divide a whole number by any fraction, multiply that whole number by
the reciprocal of that fraction.
TRY THESE
2 4 8
Find : (i) 7 ÷ (ii) 6 ÷ (iii) 2 ÷
5 7 9
l While dividing a whole number by a mixed fraction, first convert the mixed
fraction into improper fraction and then solve it.
2 12 1 10 TRY THESE
Thus, 4 ÷ 2 = 4÷ = ? Also, 5 ÷ 3 =3÷ =?
5 5 3 3
1
Find: (i) 6 ÷ 5
d
2.4.2 Division of a Fraction by a Whole Number 3
he
3 pu T 4
l What will be ÷ 3? (ii) 7 ÷ 2
4 7
is
re ER
3 3 3 1 3 1
Based on our earlier observations we have:
bl 3
÷3= ÷ = × = =
4 4 1 4 3 12 4
be NC
2 2 1 5 2
So, ÷7 = × = ? What is ÷ 6 , ÷8?
3 3 7 7 7
l While dividing mixed fractions by whole numbers, convert the mixed fractions into
©
3 3 5 5
tt
1 6
We can now find ÷ .
3 5
1 6 1 6 1 6 2
÷ = × reciprocal of = × = .
3 5 3 5 3 5 5
8 2 8 2 1 3
Similarly, ÷ = × reciprocal of =? and, ÷ = ?
5 3 5 3 2 4
TRY THESE
3 1 1 3 1 3 1 9
Find: (i) ÷ (ii) ÷ (iii) 2 ÷ (iv) 5 ÷
5 2 2 5 2 5 6 2
2020-21
46 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 2.4
1. Find:
3 5 7 8
(i) 12 ÷ (ii) 14 ÷ (iii) 8 ÷ (iv) 4 ÷
4 6 3 3
1 4
(v) 3 ÷ 2 (vi) 5 ÷ 3
3 7
2. Find the reciprocal of each of the following fractions. Classify the reciprocals as
proper fractions, improper fractions and whole numbers.
3 5 9 6
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
7 8 7 5
12 1 1
(v) (vi) (vii)
7 8 11
d
3. Find:
he
7 4 6 1
(i) ÷2 pu T
(ii) ÷5 (iii) ÷7 (iv) 4 ÷ 3
3 9 13 3
is
re ER
1 bl 3
(v) 3 ÷ 4 (vi) 4 ÷ 7
2 7
be NC
4. Find:
2 1 4 2 3 8 1 3 1 8
(i) ÷ (ii) ÷ (iii) ÷ (iv) 2 ÷ (v) 3 ÷
5 2 9 3 7 7 3 5 2 3
©
2 1 1 2 1 1
(vi) ÷1 (vii) 3 ÷ 1 (viii) 2 ÷ 1
5 2 5 3 5 5
o
You have learnt about decimal numbers in the earlier classes. Let us briefly recall them
no
here. Look at the following table and fill up the blank spaces.
Hundreds Tens Ones Tenths Hundredths Thousandths Number
1 1 1
(100) (10) (1)
10 100 1000
2 5 3 1 4 7 253.147
6 2 9 3 2 1 ..............
0 4 3 1 9 2 ..............
........ 1 4 2 5 1 514.251
2 ....... 6 5 1 2 236.512
........ 2 ........ 5 ........ 3 724.503
6 ....... 4 ........ 2 ....... 614.326
0 1 0 5 3 0 ...............
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 47
In the table, you wrote the decimal number, given its place-value expansion. You can
do the reverse, too. That is, given the number you can write its expanded form. For
1 1 1
example, 253.417 = 2 × 100 + 5 × 10 + 3 × 1 + 4 × + 1 × +7× .
10 100 1000
John has ` 15.50 and Salma has ` 15.75. Who has more money? To find this we need
to compare the decimal numbers 15.50 and 15.75. To do this, we first compare the digits
on the left of the decimal point, starting from the leftmost digit. Here both the digits 1 and
5, to the left of the decimal point, are same. So we compare the digits on the right of the
decimal point starting from the tenths place. We find that 5 < 7, so we say
15.50 < 15.75. Thus, Salma has more money than John.
If the digits at the tenths place are also same then compare the digits at the hundredths
place and so on.
d
Now compare quickly, 35.63 and 35.67; 20.1 and 20.01; 19.36 and 29.36.
he
While converting lower units of money, length and weight, to their higher units, we are
pu T 3 5
is
re ER
required to use decimals. For example, 3 paise = ` = ` 0.03, 5g = kg
bl 100 1000
= 0.005 kg, 7 cm = 0.07 m.
be NC
+ 37.35
58.71
What is the value of 0.19 + 2.3 ?
o
tt
− 04.56
24.79
Tell the value of 39.87 − 21.98.
EXERCISE 2.5
1. Which is greater?
(i) 0.5 or 0.05 (ii) 0.7 or 0.5 (iii) 7 or 0.7
(iv) 1.37 or 1.49 (v) 2.03 or 2.30 (vi) 0.8 or 0.88.
2. Express as rupees using decimals :
(i) 7 paise (ii) 7 rupees 7 paise (iii) 77 rupees 77 paise
(iv) 50 paise (v) 235 paise.
3. (i) Express 5 cm in metre and kilometre (ii) Express 35 mm in cm, m and km
2020-21
48 MATHEMATICS
4. Express in kg:
(i) 200 g (ii) 3470 g (iii) 4 kg 8 g
5. Write the following decimal numbers in the expanded form:
(i) 20.03 (ii) 2.03 (iii) 200.03 (iv) 2.034
6. Write the place value of 2 in the following decimal numbers:
(i) 2.56 (ii) 21.37 (iii) 10.25 (iv) 9.42 (v) 63.352.
7. Dinesh went from place A to place B and from
there to place C. A is 7.5 km from B and B is
12.7 km from C. Ayub went from place A to place
D and from there to place C. D is 9.3 km from A
and C is 11.8 km from D. Who travelled more
and by how much?
d
he
8. Shyama bought 5 kg 300 g apples and 3 kg 250 g mangoes. Sarala bought 4 kg 800 g
pu T
oranges and 4 kg 150 g bananas. Who bought more fruits?
is
re ER
9. How much less is 28 km than 42.6 km?
bl
2.6 MULTIPLICATION DECIMAL NUMBERS
be NC
OF
Reshma purchased 1.5kg vegetable at the rate of ` 8.50 per kg. How much money should
she pay? Certainly it would be ` (8.50 × 1.50). Both 8.5 and 1.5 are decimal numbers.
©
So, we have come across a situation where we need to know how to multiply two deci-
mals. Let us now learn the multiplication of two decimal numbers.
First we find 0.1 × 0.1.
o
1
tt
1 1 1×1 1
Now, 0.1 = . So, 0.1 × 0.1 = × = = = 0.01.
10 10 10 10 ×10 100
no
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 49
Fig 2.14
d
1 th
he
The dotted square is one part out of 10 of the part. That is, it represents
pu T 10
is
re ER
1 1
× or 0.1 × 0.1. bl
10 10
be NC
2 3
no
2020-21
50 MATHEMATICS
d
decimal numbers that are being multiplied.
he
Let us now find 1.2 × 2.5.
pu T
Multiply 12 and 25. We get 300. Both, in 1.2 and 2.5, there is 1 digit to the right
is
re ER
of the decimal point. So, count 1 + 1 = 2 digits from the rightmost digit (i.e., 0) in 300
bl
and move towards left. We get 3.00 or 3.
be NC
TRY THESE
tt
EXAMPLE 7 The side of an equilateral triangle is 3.5 cm. Find its perimeter.
SOLUTION All the sides of an equilateral triangle are equal.
So, length of each side = 3.5 cm
Thus, perimeter = 3 × 3.5 cm = 10.5 cm
EXAMPLE 8 The length of a rectangle is 7.1 cm and its breadth is 2.5 cm. What
is the area of the rectangle?
SOLUTION Length of the rectangle = 7.1 cm
Breadth of the rectangle = 2.5 cm
Therefore, area of the rectangle = 7.1 × 2.5 cm2 = 17.75 cm2
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 51
d
1.76 × 100 = × 100 = 176 or 176.0 2.35 ×100 = ___ 12.356 × 100 =___
100
he
1.76 × 1000 =
176
pu T
× 1000 = 1760 or 2.35 ×1000 = ___ 12.356 × 1000 = ___
is
re ER
100 bl
1760.0
be NC
5
0.5 × 10 = × 10 = 5 ; 0.5 × 100 = ___ ; 0.5 × 1000 = ___
10
Observe the shift of the decimal point of the products in the table. Here the numbers are
©
multiplied by 10,100 and 1000. In 1.76 × 10 = 17.6, the digits are same i.e., 1, 7 and 6. Do
you observe this in other products also? Observe 1.76 and 17.6. To which side has the
decimal point shifted, right or left? The decimal point has shifted to the right by one place.
o
In 1.76×100 = 176.0, observe 1.76 and 176.0. To which side and by how many
no
digits has the decimal point shifted? The decimal point has shifted to the right by two
places.
Note that 100 has two zeros over one.
Do you observe similar shifting of decimal point in other products also?
So we say, when a decimal number is multiplied by 10, 100 or 1000, the digits in
the product are same as in the decimal number but the decimal
point in the product is shifted to the right by as, many of places as
there are zeros over one.
TRY THESE
Find: (i) 0.3 × 10
Based on these observations we can now say
(ii) 1.2 × 100
0.07 × 10 = 0.7, 0.07 × 100 = 7 and 0.07 × 1000 = 70.
(iii) 56.3 × 1000
Can you now tell 2.97 × 10 = ? 2.97 × 100 = ? 2.97 × 1000 = ?
Can you now help Reshma to find the total amount i.e., ` 8.50 × 150, that she has
to pay?
2020-21
52 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 2.6
1. Find:
(i) 0.2 × 6 (ii) 8 × 4.6 (iii) 2.71 × 5 (iv) 20.1 × 4
(v) 0.05 × 7 (vi) 211.02 × 4 (vii) 2 × 0.86
2. Find the area of rectangle whose length is 5.7cm and breadth is 3 cm.
3. Find:
(i) 1.3 × 10 (ii) 36.8 × 10 (iii) 153.7 × 10 (iv) 168.07 × 10
(v) 31.1 × 100 (vi) 156.1 × 100 (vii) 3.62 × 100 (viii) 43.07 × 100
(ix) 0.5 × 10 (x) 0.08 × 10 (xi) 0.9 × 100 (xii) 0.03 × 1000
4. A two-wheeler covers a distance of 55.3 km in one litre of petrol. How much distance
will it cover in 10 litres of petrol?
d
5. Find:
he
(i) 2.5 × 0.3 pu T (ii) 0.1 × 51.7 (iii) 0.2 × 316.8 (iv) 1.3 × 3.1
(v) 0.5 × 0.05 (vi) 11.2 × 0.15 (vii) 1.07 × 0.02
is
re ER
(viii) 10.05 × 1.05 (ix) 101.01 × 0.01
bl (x) 100.01 × 1.1
Savita was preparing a design to decorate her classroom. She needed a few coloured
strips of paper of length 1.9 cm each. She had a strip of coloured paper of length 9.5 cm.
How many pieces of the required length will she get out of this strip? She thought it would
©
9.5
be cm. Is she correct?
1.9
Both 9.5 and 1.9 are decimal numbers. So we need to know the division of
o
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 53
Take 31.5 ÷ 10 = 3.15. In 31.5 and 3.15, the digits are TRY THESE
same i.e., 3, 1, and 5 but the decimal point has shifted in the
quotient. To which side and by how many digits? The decimal Find: (i) 235.4 ÷ 10
point has shifted to the left by one place. Note that 10 has one (ii) 235.4 ÷100
zero over 1.
Consider now 31.5 ÷ 100 = 0.315. In 31.5 and 0.315 the (iii) 235.4 ÷ 1000
digits are same, but what about the decimal point in the quotient?
It has shifted to the left by two places. Note that 100 has two zeros over1.
So we can say that, while dividing a number by 10, 100 or 1000, the digits of the
number and the quotient are same but the decimal point in the quotient shifts to the
left by as many places as there are zeros over 1. Using this observation let us now
quickly find: 2.38 ÷ 10 = 0.238, 2.38 ÷ 100 = 0.0238, 2.38 ÷ 1000 = 0.00238
d
2.7.2 Division of a Decimal Number by a Whole Number
he
Let us find
6.4
pu T
. Remember we also write it as 6.4 ÷ 2. TRY THESE
is
re ER
2 bl (i) 35.7 ÷ 3 = ?;
64 64 1 (ii) 25.5 ÷ 3 = ?
be NC
Or, let us first divide 64 by 2. We get 32. There is one digit to the right of the decimal
point in 6.4. Place the decimal in 32 such that there would be one digit to its
right. We get 3.2 again.
o
TRY THESE
tt
To find 19.5 ÷ 5, first find 195 ÷5. We get 39. There is one digit to the
right of the decimal point in 19.5. Place the decimal point in 39 such that there (i) 43.15 ÷ 5 = ?;
no
would be one digit to its right. You will get 3.9. (ii) 82.44 ÷ 6 = ?
1296 1296 1 1 1296 1
Now, 12.96 ÷ 4 = ÷4 = × = × = × 324 = 3.24
100 100 4 100 4 100
Or, divide 1296 by 4. You get 324. There are two digits to the right of the decimal in
12.96. Making similar placement of the decimal in 324, you will get 3.24.
Note that here and in the next section, we have considered only those TRY THESE
divisions in which, ignoring the decimal, the number would be completely Find: (i) 15.5 ÷ 5
divisible by another number to give remainder zero. Like, in 19.5 ÷ 5, the
number 195 when divided by 5, leaves remainder zero. (ii) 126.35 ÷ 7
However, there are situations in which the number may not be completely
divisible by another number, i.e., we may not get remainder zero. For example, 195 ÷ 7.
We deal with such situations in later classes.
2020-21
54 MATHEMATICS
d
0.5
he
decimal in 0.5. This could be converted to whole number by dividing by 10. Accordingly
pu T
25.5 was also converted to a fraction by dividing by 10.
is
re ER
Or, we say the decimal point was shifted by one place to the right in 0.5 to make it 5.
bl
So, there was a shift of one decimal point to the right in 25.5 also to make it 255.
be NC
22.5 225
Thus, 22.5 ÷ 1.5 = = = 15 TRY THESE
1.5 15
20.3 15.2 7.75 42.8 5.6
Find and in a similar way. Find: (i) (ii) (iii)
©
0.4 0.3
33.725 3372.5
no
2020-21
FRACTIONS AND DECIMALS 55
EXAMPLE 11 A car covers a distance of 89.1 km in 2.2 hours. What is the average
distance covered by it in 1 hour?
SOLUTION Distance covered by the car = 89.1 km.
Time required to cover this distance = 2.2 hours.
89.1 891
So distance covered by it in 1 hour = = = 40.5 km.
2.2 22
EXERCISE 2.7
1. Find:
(i) 0.4 ÷ 2 (ii) 0.35 ÷ 5 (iii) 2.48 ÷ 4 (iv) 65.4 ÷ 6
(v) 651.2 ÷ 4 (vi) 14.49 ÷ 7 (vii) 3.96 ÷ 4 (viii) 0.80 ÷ 5
d
2. Find:
he
(i) 4.8 ÷ 10 (ii) 52.5 ÷ 10 (iii) 0.7 ÷ 10 (iv) 33.1 ÷ 10
(v) 272.23 ÷ 10 (vi) 0.56 ÷ 10
pu T (vii) 3.97 ÷10
is
re ER
3. Find: bl
(i) 2.7 ÷ 100 (ii) 0.3 ÷ 100 (iii) 0.78 ÷ 100
be NC
(v) 0.5 ÷ 0.25 (vi) 7.75 ÷ 0.25 (vii) 76.5 ÷ 0.15 (viii) 37.8 ÷ 1.4
(ix) 2.73 ÷ 1.3
no
6. A vehicle covers a distance of 43.2 km in 2.4 litres of petrol. How much distance will
it cover in one litre of petrol?
2020-21
56 MATHEMATICS
5. (a) The product of two proper fractions is less than each of the fractions that are
multiplied.
(b) The product of a proper and an improper fraction is less than the improper
fraction and greater than the proper fraction.
(c) The product of two imporper fractions is greater than the two fractions.
6. A reciprocal of a fraction is obtained by inverting it upside down.
7. We have seen how to divide two fractions.
(a) While dividing a whole number by a fraction, we multiply the whole number
with the reciprocal of that fraction.
3 5 10
For example, 2 ÷ = 2 × =
5 3 3
(b) While dividing a fraction by a whole number we multiply the fraction by the
reciprocal of the whole number.
d
2 2 1 2
he
For example, ÷7= × =
3
pu T 3 7 21
(c) While dividing one fraction by another fraction, we multuiply the first fraction by
is
re ER
bl 2 5 2 7 14
the reciprocal of the other. So, ÷ = × = .
3 7 3 5 15
be NC
8. We also learnt how to multiply two decimal numbers. While multiplying two decimal
numbers, first multiply them as whole numbers. Count the number of digits to the right
of the decimal point in both the decimal numbers. Add the number of digits counted.
Put the decimal point in the product by counting the digits from its rightmost place.
©
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 57
Chapter 3
Data
Handling
d
3.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
In your previous classes, you have dealt with various types of data. You have learnt to
is
re ER
collect data, tabulate and put it in the form of bar graphs. The collection, recording and
presentation of data help us organise our experiences and draw inferences from them.
bl
In this Chapter, we will take one more step towards learning how to do this. You will
be NC
come across some more kinds of data and graphs. You have seen several kinds of data
through newspapers, magazines, television and other sources. You also know that all
data give us some sort of information. Let us look at some common forms of data that
©
2020-21
58 MATHEMATICS
d
he
This shows that a given collection of data may not give us a specific information related
pu T
to that data. For this we need to collect data keeping in mind that specific information. In
is
re ER
the above case the specific information needed by us, was about the highest maximum
temperature of the cities during the year, which we could not get from Table 3.1
bl
Thus, before collecting data, we need to know what we would use it for.
be NC
– Number of children below the age of five in the families around you.
tt
What kind of data would you need in the above situations? Unless and until you collect
no
appropriate data, you cannot know the desired information. What is the appropriate data
for each?
Discuss with your friends and identify the data you would need for each.
Some of this data is easy to collect and some difficult.
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 59
Neelam’s colleague helped her organise the data in the following way (Table 3.4).
Table 3.4
In this form, Neelam was able to know which student has got how many marks. But she
d
wanted more. Deepika suggested another way to organise this data (Table 3.5).
he
pu T
Table 3.5
is
re ER
Roll No. Names Marks blRoll No. Names Marks
Out of 50 Out of 50
be NC
3 Ashish 48 4 Dipti 30
6 Govind 46 8 Kavita 27
10 Neeraj 38 5 Faizaan 25
©
2 Armaan 35 1 Ajay 23
9 Manisha 32 7 Jay 13
o
tt
Now Neelam was able to see who had done the best and who needed help.
Many kinds of data we come across are put in tabular form. Our school rolls, progress
no
report, index in the notebooks, temperature record and many others are all in tabular
form. Can you think of a few more data that you come across in tabular form?
When we put data in a proper table it becomes easy to understand and interpret.
TRY THESE
Weigh (in kg) atleast 20 children (girls and boys) of your class. Organise the data, and
answer the following questions using this data.
(i) Who is the heaviest of all? (ii) What is the most common weight?
(iii) What is the difference between your weight and that of your best friend?
2020-21
60 MATHEMATICS
l The average temperature at this time of the year is about 40 degree celsius.
l The average age of pupils in my class is 12 years.
l The average attendance of students in a school during its final examination was
98 per cent.
Many more of such statements could be there. Think about the statements given above.
Do you think that the child in the first statement studies exactly for 5 hours daily?
Or, is the temperature of the given place during that particular time always 40 degrees?
Or, is the age of each pupil in that class 12 years? Obviously not.
Then what do these statements tell you?
By average we understand that Isha, usually, studies for 5 hours. On some days,
she may study for less number of hours and on the other days she may study longer.
d
Similarly, the average temperature of 40 degree celsius, means that, very often,
he
the temperature at this time of the year is around 40 degree celsius. Sometimes, it may
pu T
be less than 40 degree celsius and at other times, it may be more than 40°C.
is
re ER
Thus, we realise that average is a number that represents or shows the central tendency
bl
of a group of observations or data. Since average lies between the highest and the lowest
be NC
value of the given data so, we say average is a measure of the central tendency of the group
of data. Different forms of data need different forms of representative or central value to
describe it. One of these representative values is the “Arithmetic mean”. You will learn
about the other representative values in the later part of the chapter.
©
The most common representative value of a group of data is the arithmetic mean or the
tt
mean. To understand this in a better way, let us look at the following example:
Two vessels contain 20 litres and 60 litres of milk respectively. What is the amount that
no
each vessel would have, if both share the milk equally? When we ask this question we are
seeking the arithmetic mean.
In the above case, the average or the arithmetic mean would be
Total quantity of milk 20 + 60
= litres = 40 litres.
Number of vessels 2
Thus, each vessels would have 40 litres of milk.
The average or Arithmetic Mean (A.M.) or simply mean is defined as follows:
Sum of all observations
mean =
number of observations
Consider these examples.
EXAMPLE 1 Ashish studies for 4 hours, 5 hours and 3 hours respectively on three
consecutive days. How many hours does he study daily on an average?
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 61
d
Where does the arithmetic mean lie
he
TRY THESE
pu T
is
re ER
bl
How would you find the average of your study hours for the whole week?
be NC
Consider the data in the above examples and think on the following:
l Is the mean bigger than each of the observations?
l Is it smaller than each observation?
o
Discuss with your friends. Frame one more example of this type and answer the
same questions.
tt
You will find that the mean lies inbetween the greatest and the smallest observations.
no
In particular, the mean of two numbers will always lie between the two numbers.
5 + 11
For example the mean of 5 and 11 is = 8 , which lies between 5 and 11.
2
Can you use this idea to show that between any two fractional numbers, you can find
1 1
as many fractional numbers as you like. For example between and you have their
2 4
1 1
+ 3 1 3 7
average 2 4 = and then between and , you have their average
2 8 2 8 16
and so on.
TRY THESE
1. Find the mean of your sleeping hours during one week.
1 1
2. Find atleast 5 numbers between and .
2 3
2020-21
62 MATHEMATICS
3.5.1 Range
The difference between the highest and the lowest observation gives us an idea of the
spread of the observations. This can be found by subtracting the lowest observation from
the highest observation. We call the result the range of the observation. Look at the
following example:
EXAMPLE 3 The ages in years of 10 teachers of a school are:
32, 41, 28, 54, 35, 26, 23, 33, 38, 40
(i) What is the age of the oldest teacher and that of the youngest teacher?
(ii) What is the range of the ages of the teachers?
(iii) What is the mean age of these teachers?
SOLUTION
d
he
(i) Arranging the ages in ascending order, we get:
pu T
23, 26, 28, 32, 33, 35, 38, 40, 41, 54
is
re ER
We find that the age of the oldest teacher is 54 years and the age of the youngest
bl
teacher is 23 years.
be NC
(ii) Range of the ages of the teachers = (54 – 23) years = 31 years
(iii) Mean age of the teachers
23 + 26 + 28 + 32 + 33 + 35 + 38 + 40 + 41 + 54
©
= years
10
350
years = 35 years
o
=
10
tt
EXERCISE 3.1
no
4, 6, 7, 5, 3, 5, 4, 5, 2, 6, 2, 5, 1, 9, 6, 5, 8, 4, 6, 7
(i) Which number is the highest? (ii) Which number is the lowest?
(iii) What is the range of the data? (iv) Find the arithmetic mean.
3. Find the mean of the first five whole numbers.
4. A cricketer scores the following runs in eight innings:
58, 76, 40, 35, 46, 45, 0, 100.
Find the mean score.
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 63
5. Following table shows the points of each player scored in four games:
Player Game Game Game Game
1 2 3 4
A 14 16 10 10
B 0 8 6 4
C 8 11 Did not 13
Play
Now answer the following questions:
(i) Find the mean to determine A’s average number of points scored per game.
(ii) To find the mean number of points per game for C, would you divide the total
points by 3 or by 4? Why?
d
he
(iii) B played in all the four games. How would you find the mean?
(iv) Who is the best performer?
pu T
is
re ER
6. The marks (out of 100) obtained by a group of students in a science test are 85, 76,
bl
90, 85, 39, 48, 56, 95, 81 and 75. Find the:
be NC
8. The rainfall (in mm) in a city on 7 days of a certain week was recorded as follows:
no
2020-21
64 MATHEMATICS
3.6 MODE
As we have said Mean is not the only measure of central tendency or the only form of
representative value. For different requirements from a data, other measures of central
tendencies are used.
d
he
Total number of shirts sold 105
Mean of total shirts sold =
pu T = = 21
Number of different sizes of shiirts 5
is
re ER
Should he obtain 21 shirts of each size? If he does so, will he be able to cater to the
bl
needs of the customers?
be NC
The shopkeeper, on looking at the record, decides to procure shirts of sizes 95 cm,
100 cm, 105 cm. He decided to postpone the procurement of the shirts of other sizes
because of their small number of buyers.
©
Observe that here also, the owner is concerned about the number
tt
of shirts of different sizes sold. She is however looking at the shirt size
that is sold the most. This is another representative value for the data.
no
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 65
d
he
3 pu T 7
4 5
is
re ER
5 bl 3
6 2
be NC
Total 40
Looking at the table, we can quickly say that 2 is the ‘mode’ since 2 has occured the
©
highest number of times. Thus, most of the matches have been won with a victory margin
of 2 goals.
AND
tt
DO THIS
1. Record the age in years of all your classmates. Tabulate the data and find the mode.
2. Record the heights in centimetres of your classmates and find the mode.
TRY THESE
1. Find the mode of the following data:
12, 14, 12, 16, 15, 13, 14, 18, 19, 12, 14, 15, 16, 15, 16, 16, 15,
17, 13, 16, 16, 15, 15, 13, 15, 17, 15, 14, 15, 13, 15, 14
2020-21
66 MATHEMATICS
Whereas mean gives us the average of all observations of the data, the mode gives that
observation which occurs most frequently in the data.
Let us consider the following examples:
(a) You have to decide upon the number of chapattis needed for 25 people called for a
feast.
(b) A shopkeeper selling shirts has decided to replenish her stock.
(c) We need to find the height of the door needed in our house.
d
he
(d) When going on a picnic, if only one fruit can be bought for everyone, which is the
pu T
fruit that we would get.
is
re ER
In which of these situations can we use the mode as a good estimate?
bl
Consider the first statement. Suppose the number of chapattis needed by each person
be NC
is 2, 3, 2, 3, 2, 1, 2, 3, 2, 2, 4, 2, 2, 3, 2, 4, 4, 2, 3, 2, 4, 2, 4, 3, 5
The mode of the data is 2 chapattis. If we use mode as the representative value for this
data, then we need 50 chapattis only, 2 for each of the 25 persons. However the total
©
of each of 5 children is around 135 cm. The mode for the heights is
tt
135 cm. Should we get a door that is 144 cm high? Would all the
no
adults be able to go through that door? It is clear that mode is not the
appropriate representative value for this data. Would mean be an
appropriate representative value here?
Why not? Which representative value of height should be used to
decide the doorheight?
Similarly analyse the rest of the statements and find the representative
value useful for that issue.
TRY THESE
Discuss with your friends and give
(a) Two situations where mean would be an appropriate representative value to
use, and
(b) Two situations where mode would be an appropriate representative value to use.
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 67
3.7 MEDIAN
We have seen that in some situations, arithmetic mean is an appropriate measure of central
tendency whereas in some other situations, mode is the appropriate measure of central
tendency.
Let us now look at another example. Consider a group of 17 students with the following
heights (in cm): 106, 110, 123, 125, 117, 120, 112, 115, 110, 120, 115, 102, 115, 115,
109, 115, 101.
The games teacher wants to divide the class into two groups so that each group has
equal number of students, one group has students with height lesser than a particular height
and the other group has students with heights greater than the particular height. How
would she do that?
Let us see the various options she has:
d
(i) She can find the mean. The mean is
he
pu T
106 + 110 + 123 + 125 + 117 + 120 + 112 + 115 + 110 + 120 + 115 + 102 + 115 + 115 + 109 + 115 + 101
is
re ER
17
1930 bl
= = 113.5
17
be NC
So, if the teacher divides the students into two groups on the basis of this mean height,
such that one group has students of height less than the mean height and the other group
has students with height more than the mean height, then the groups would be of unequal
©
There are 7 children below the mode and 10 children at the mode and above the
tt
2020-21
68 MATHEMATICS
Note that in general, we may not get the same value for median and mode.
Thus we realise that mean, mode and median are the numbers that are the representative
values of a group of observations or data. They lie between the minimum and maximum
values of the data. They are also called the measures of the central tendency.
EXAMPLE 7 Find the median of the data: 24, 36, 46, 17, 18, 25, 35
SOLUTION We arrange the data in ascending order, we get 17, 18, 24, 25, 35, 36, 46
Median is the middle observation. Therefore 25 is the median.
EXERCISE 3.2
1. The scores in mathematics test (out of 25) of 15 students is as follows:
19, 25, 23, 20, 9, 20, 15, 10, 5, 16, 25, 20, 24, 12, 20
Find the mode and median of this data. Are they same?
d
2. The runs scored in a cricket match by 11 players is as follows:
he
pu T
6, 15, 120, 50, 100, 80, 10, 15, 8, 10, 15
is
re ER
Find the mean, mode and median of this data. Are the three same?
bl
3. The weights (in kg.) of 15 students of a class are:
38, 42, 35, 37, 45, 50, 32, 43, 43, 40, 36, 38, 43, 38, 47
be NC
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 69
EXAMPLE 8 Two hundred students of 6th and 7th classes were asked to name their
favourite colour so as to decide upon what should be the colour of their
school building. The results are shown in the following table. Represent
the given data on a bar graph.
Favourite Colour Red Green Blue Yellow Orange
Number of Students 43 19 55 49 34
Answer the following questions with the help of the bar graph:
(i) Which is the most preferred colour and which is the least preferred?
(ii) How many colours are there in all? What are they?
d
follows:
he
Start the scale at 0. The greatest value in the
pu T
data is 55, so end the scale at a value greater
is
re ER
than 55, such as 60. Use equal divisions alongbl
the axes, such as increments of 10. You know
be NC
(i) Blue is the most preferred colour (Because the bar representing Blue is the tallest).
(ii) Green is the least preferred colour. (Because the bar representing Green is the
no
shortest).
(iii) There are five colours. They are Red, Green, Blue, Yellow and Orange. (These are
observed on the horizontal line)
EXAMPLE 9 Following data gives total marks (out of 600) obtained by six children of
a particular class. Represent the data on a bar graph.
SOLUTION
(i) To choose an appropriate scale we make equal divisions taking increments of 100.
Thus 1 unit will represent 100 marks. (What would be the difficulty if we choose one
unit to represent 10 marks?)
2020-21
70 MATHEMATICS
d
Drawing double bar graph
he
Consider the following two collections of data giving the average daily hours of sunshine in
pu T
two cities Aberdeen and Margate for all the twelve months of the year. These cities are
is
re ER
near the south pole and hence have only a few hours of sunshine each day.
bl
In Margate
be NC
Jan. Feb. Mar. April May June July Aug. Sept. Oct. Nov. Dec.
Average
©
hours of 2 1 4 4 3 8 1 7 1 6 4 2
3 7 7 6
4 4 2 4
Sunshine
In Aberdeen
o
tt
Average
1 1 1 1 1 1 3
hours of 1 3 3 6 5 6 5 5 4 4 3 1
no
2 2 2 2 2 2 4
Sunshine
By drawing individual bar graphs you could answer questions like
(i) In which month does each city has maximum sunlight? or
(ii) In which months does each city has minimum sunlight?
However, to answer questions like “In a particular month, which city has more sunshine
hours”, we need to compare the average hours of sunshine of both the cities. To do this we
will learn to draw what is called a double bar graph giving the information of both cities
side-by-side.
This bar graph (Fig 3.1) shows the average sunshine of both the cities.
For each month we have two bars, the heights of which give the average hours of
sunshine in each city. From this we can infer that except for the month of April, there is
always more sunshine in Margate than in Aberdeen. You could put together a similiar bar
graph for your area or for your city.
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 71
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl Fig 3.1
be NC
the scores of the 5 weakest children in the quarterly test (out of 25) and
in the half yearly test (out of 25):
o
Quarterly 10 15 12 20 9
no
Half yearly 15 18 16 21 15
SOLUTION She draws the adjoining double bar graph and finds a marked
improvement in most of the students, the teacher decides
that she should continue to use the new technique of teaching.
Can you think of a few more situations where you could use double
bar graphs?
TRY THESE
1. The bar graph (Fig 3.2) shows the result of a survey to test water resistant watches
made by different companies.
Each of these companies claimed that their watches were water resistant. After a
test the above results were revealed.
2020-21
72 MATHEMATICS
d
language books least?.
he
Fig 3.2 (b) Can you say that the demand for English books rose
pu T
is
faster? Justify.
re ER
bl
be NC
EXERCISE 3.3
1. Use the bar graph (Fig 3.3) to answer the following questions.
(a) Which is the most popular pet? (b) How many students have dog as a pet?
©
o
tt
no
2. Read the bar graph (Fig 3.4) which shows the number of books sold by a bookstore
during five consecutive years and answer the following questions:
(i) About how many books were sold in 1989? 1990? 1992?
(ii) In which year were about 475 books sold? About 225 books sold?
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 73
d
graph choosing appropriate scale and answer the following:
he
Subject English
pu T
Hindi Maths Science S. Science
is
re ER
1st Term (M.M. 100) 67 bl 72 88 81 73
2nd Term (M.M. 100) 70 65 95 85 75
be NC
(i) In which subject, has the child improved his performance the most?
(ii) In which subject is the improvement the least?
©
2020-21
74 MATHEMATICS
d
happen i.e., the next test series or lose it. Both are possible.
he
situations that
have some 3.9.1 Chance pu T
is
If you toss a coin, can you always correctly predict what you will get? Try tossing
re ER
chance of
happening. a coin and predicting the outcome each time. Write your observations in the
bl
following table:
be NC
Do this 10 times. Look at the observed outcomes. Can you see a pattern in them?
What do you get after each head? Is it that you get head all the time? Repeat the observation
for another 10 tosses and write the observations in the table.
o
You will find that the observations show no clear pattern. In the table below we give
tt
you observations generated in 25 tosses by Sushila and Salma. Here H represents Head
and T represents Tail.
no
Numbers 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
Outcome H T T H T T T H T T H H H H H
Numbers 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
Outcome T T H T T T T T T T
What does this data tell you? Can you find a predictable pattern for head and tail?
Clearly there is no fixed pattern of occurrence of head and tail. When you throw the coin
each time the outcome of every throw can be either head or tail. It is a matter of chance
that in one particular throw you get either of these.
In the above data, count the number of heads and the number of tails. Throw the coin
some more times and keep recording what you obtain. Find out the total number of times
you get a head and the total number of times you get a tail.
You also might have played with a die. The die has six faces. When you throw a die,
can you predict the number that will be obtained? While playing ludo or snake and ladders
you may have often wished that in a throw you get a particular outcome.
2020-21
DATA HANDLING 75
Does the die always fall according to your wishes? Take a die and throw it 150
times and fill the data in the following table:
Number on Die Tally Marks Number of Times it Occured
1
2
Make a tally mark each time you get the outcome, against the appropriate number.
For example in the first throw you get 5. Put a tally in front of 5. The next throw gives
you 1. Make a tally for 1. Keep on putting tally marks for the appropriate number.
Repeat this exercise for 150 throws and find out the number of each outcome for 150
throws.
Make bar graph using the above data showing the number of times 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6
have occured in the data.
d
he
TRY THESE pu T
(Do in a group)
is
re ER
1. Toss a coin 100 times and record the data. Find the number of times heads and tails
bl
occur in it.
be NC
2. Aftaab threw a die 250 times and got the following table. Draw a bar graph for this data.
Number on the Die Tally Marks
1
©
4 |||| |||| |||| |||| ||||| |||| |||| |||| |||| |||| ||
no
2020-21
76 MATHEMATICS
have done, it may perhaps be obvious that events that have many possibilities can
TRY THESE have probability between 0 and 1. Those which have no chance of happening have
Construct or probability 0 and those that are bound to happen have probability 1.
think of five Given any situation we need to understand the different possible outcomes
situations where and study the possible chances for each outcome. It may be possible that the
outcomes do not outcomes may not have equal chance of occuring unlike the cases of the coin and
have equal die. For example, if a container has 15 red balls and 9 white balls and if a ball is
chances. pulled out without seeing, the chances of getting a red ball are much more. Can
you see why? How many times are the chances of getting a red ball than getting
a white ball, probabilities for both being between 0 and 1.
EXERCISE 3.4
d
1. Tell whether the following is certain to happen, impossible, can happen but not certain.
he
(i) You are older today than yesterday. (ii) A tossed coin will land heads up.
pu T
(iii) A die when tossed shall land up with 8 on top.
(iv) The next traffic light seen will be green. (v) Tomorrow will be a cloudy day.
is
re ER
2. There are 6 marbles in a box with numbers from 1 to 6 marked on each of them.
bl
(i) What is the probability of drawing a marble with number 2?
be NC
3. The data that is collected needs to be organised in a proper table, so that it becomes
easy to understand and interpret.
no
2020-21
SIMPLE EQUATIONS 77
Chapter 4
Simple
Equations
d
4.1 A MIND-READING GAME!
he
pu T
The teacher has said that she would be starting a new chapter in
is
re ER
mathematics and it is going to be simple equations. Appu, Sarita
and Ameena have revised what they learnt in algebra chapter in
bl
Class VI. Have you? Appu, Sarita and Ameena are excited because
be NC
they have constructed a game which they call mind reader and they
want to present it to the whole class.
The teacher appreciates their enthusiasm and invites them to present their game. Ameena
©
begins; she asks Sara to think of a number, multiply it by 4 and add 5 to the product. Then,
she asks Sara to tell the result. She says it is 65. Ameena instantly declares that the number
Sara had thought of is 15. Sara nods. The whole class including Sara is surprised.
o
It is Appu’s turn now. He asks Balu to think of a number, multiply it by 10 and subtract
tt
20 from the product. He then asks Balu what his result is? Balu says it is 50. Appu
no
2020-21
78 MATHEMATICS
To find the number thought by Sara let us work backward from her answer 65. We
have to find x such that
4x + 5 = 65 (4.1)
Solution to the equation will give us the number which Sara held in her mind.
Let us similarly look at Appu’s example. Let us call the number Balu chose as y. Appu
asks Balu to multiply the number by 10 and subtract 20 from the product. That is, from y,
Balu first gets 10y and from there (10y – 20). The result is known to be 50.
Therefore, 10y – 20 = 50 (4.2)
The solution of this equation will give us the number Balu had thought of.
d
Note, (4.1) and (4.2) are equations. Let us recall what we learnt about equations in
he
Class VI. An equation is a condition on a variable. In equation (4.1), the variable is x;
pu T
in equation (4.2), the variable is y.
is
re ER
The word variable means something that can vary, i.e. change. A variable takes on
bl
different numerical values; its value is not fixed. Variables are denoted usually by
be NC
formed the expression (10y – 20). For this, we multiplied y by 10 and then subtracted 20
from the product. All these are examples of expressions.
o
The value of an expression thus formed depends upon the chosen value of the variable.
tt
TRY THESE
The value of the expression (10y – 20) depends on the value of y. Verify this by
giving five different values to y and finding for each y the value of (10 y – 20). From
the different values of (10y – 20) you obtain, do you see a solution to 10y – 20 = 50?
If there is no solution, try giving more values to y and find whether the condition
10y – 20 = 50 is met.
2020-21
SIMPLE EQUATIONS 79
If there is some sign other than the equality sign between the LHS and the RHS, it is
not an equation. Thus, 4x + 5 > 65 is not an equation.
It says that, the value of (4x + 5) is greater than 65.
Similarly, 4x + 5 < 65 is not an equation. It says that the value of (4x + 5) is smaller
than 65.
d
In equations, we often find that the RHS is just a number. In Equation (4.1), it is 65
he
and in equation (4.2), it is 50. But this need not be always so. The RHS of an equation may
pu T
be an expression containing the variable. For example, the equation
is
re ER
4x + 5 = 6x – 25
bl
has the expression (4x + 5) on the left and (6x – 25) on the right of the equality sign.
be NC
and on the right are interchanged. This property is often useful in solving equations.
tt
2020-21
80 MATHEMATICS
m
(iii) One fourth of m is .
4
m
It is greater than 7 by 3. This means the difference ( – 7) is 3.
4
m
The equation is – 7 = 3.
4
n
(iv) Take the number to be n. One third of n is .
3
n
This one-third plus 5 is + 5. It is 8.
3
n
The equation is + 5 = 8.
3
EXAMPLE 2 Convert the following equations in statement form:
m
(i) x – 5 = 9 (ii) 5p = 20 (iii) 3n + 7 = 1 (iv) –2=6
d
5
he
SOLUTION (i) Taking away 5 from x gives 9.
pu T
(ii) Five times a number p is 20.
is
re ER
(iii) Add 7 to three times n to get 1.
bl
(iv) You get 6, when you subtract 2 from one-fifth of a number m.
be NC
What is important to note is that for a given equation, not just one, but many statement
forms can be given. For example, for Equation (i) above, you can say:
Subtract 5 from x, you get 9.
TRY THESE or The number x is 5 more than 9.
©
Write atleast one other form for or The number x is greater by 5 than 9.
each equation (ii), (iii) and (iv). or The difference between x and 5 is 9, and so on.
EXAMPLE 3 Consider the following situation:
o
tt
Raju’s father’s age is 5 years more than three times Raju’s age. Raju’s father is 44 years
old. Set up an equation to find Raju’s age.
no
SOLUTION We do not know Raju’s age. Let us take it to be y years. Three times
Raju’s age is 3y years. Raju’s father’s age is 5 years more than 3y; that
is, Raju’s father is (3y + 5) years old. It is also given that Raju’s father
is 44 years old.
Therefore, 3y + 5 = 44 (4.3)
This is an equation in y. It will give Raju’s age when solved.
EXAMPLE 4 A shopkeeper sells mangoes in two types of boxes, one small and one
large. A large box contains as many as 8 small boxes plus 4 loose mangoes.
Set up an equation which gives the number of mangoes in each small box.
The number of mangoes in a large box is given to be 100.
SOLUTION Let a small box contain m mangoes. A large box contains 4 more than 8
times m, that is, 8m + 4 mangoes. But this is given to be 100. Thus
8m + 4 = 100 (4.4)
You can get the number of mangoes in a small box by solving this equation.
2020-21
SIMPLE EQUATIONS 81
EXERCISE 4.1
1. Complete the last column of the table.
S. Equation Value Say, whether the Equation
No. is Satisfied. (Yes/ No)
(i) x+3=0 x=3
(ii) x+3=0 x=0
(iii) x+3=0 x=–3
(iv) x–7=1 x=7
(v) x–7=1 x=8
(vi) 5x = 25 x=0
d
(vii) 5x = 25 x=5
he
(viii) 5x = 25 x=–5 pu T
m
is
re ER
(ix) =2 m=–6
3 bl
m
be NC
(x) =2 m=0
3
m
(xi) =2 m=6
3
©
2. Check whether the value given in the brackets is a solution to the given equation
or not:
o
(i) 5p + 2 = 17 (ii) 3m – 14 = 4
4. Write equations for the following statements:
(i) The sum of numbers x and 4 is 9. (ii) 2 subtracted from y is 8.
(iii) Ten times a is 70. (iv) The number b divided by 5 gives 6.
(v) Three-fourth of t is 15. (vi) Seven times m plus 7 gets you 77.
(vii) One-fourth of a number x minus 4 gives 4.
(viii) If you take away 6 from 6 times y, you get 60.
(ix) If you add 3 to one-third of z, you get 30.
5. Write the following equations in statement forms:
m
(i) p + 4 = 15 (ii) m – 7 = 3 (iii) 2m = 7 (iv) =3
5
3m p
(v) =6 (vi) 3p + 4 = 25 (vii) 4p – 2 = 18 (viii) +2=8
5 2
2020-21
82 MATHEMATICS
d
he
Consider an equality 8–3=4+1 (4.5)
pu T
The equality (4.5) holds, since both its sides are equal (each is equal to 5).
is
re ER
l Let us now add 2 to both sides; as a result
bl
LHS = 8 – 3 + 2 = 5 + 2 = 7 RHS = 4 + 1 + 2 = 5 + 2 = 7.
be NC
Again the equality holds (i.e., its LHS and RHS are equal).
Thus if we add the same number to both sides of an equality, it still holds.
l Let us now subtract 2 from both the sides; as a result,
©
LHS = 8 – 3 – 2 = 5 – 2 = 3 RHS = 4 + 1 – 2 = 5 – 2 = 3.
Again, the equality holds.
o
Thus if we subtract the same number from both sides of an equality, it still holds.
tt
l Similarly, if we multiply or divide both sides of the equality by the same non-zero
no
2020-21
SIMPLE EQUATIONS 83
hold (i.e., its both sides are not equal). For example, let us take again equality (4.5),
8–3=4+1
add 2 to the LHS and 3 to the RHS. The new LHS is 8 – 3 + 2 = 5 + 2 = 7 and the new
RHS is 4 + 1 + 3 = 5 + 3 = 8. The equality does not hold, because the new LHS and RHS
are not equal.
Thus if we fail to do the same mathematical operation with same number on
both sides of an equality, the equality may not hold.
The equality that involves variables is an equation.
These conclusions are also valid for equations, as in each equation variable
represents a number only.
Often an equation is said to be like a weighing balance. Doing a mathematical operation
on an equation is like adding weights to or removing weights from the pans of a weighing
d
balance.
he
pu T
An equation is like a weighing balance with equal weights on
is
re ER
both its pans, in which case the arm of the balance is exactly
bl
horizontal. If we add the same weights to both the pans, the arm
remains horizontal. Similarly, if we remove the same weights from
be NC
both the pans, the arm remains horizontal. On the other hand if we
add different weights to the pans or remove different weights from L.H.S. R.H.S.
them, the balance is tilted; that is, the arm of the balance does not A balanced equation is like a
©
the balance is imaginary and numbers can be used as weights that can be physically
tt
balanced against each other. This is the real purpose in presenting the principle. Let us
take some examples.
no
2020-21
84 MATHEMATICS
To confirm whether we are right, we shall put x = 5 in the original equation. We get
LHS = x + 3 = 5 + 3 = 8, which is equal to the RHS as required.
By doing the right mathematical operation (i.e., subtracting 3) on both the sides of the
equation, we arrived at the solution of the equation.
l Let us look at another equation x – 3 = 10 (4.7)
What should we do here? We should add 3 to both the sides, By doing so, we shall
retain the balance and also the LHS will reduce to just x.
New LHS = x – 3 + 3 = x , New RHS = 10 + 3 = 13
Therefore, x = 13, which is the required solution.
By putting x = 13 in the original equation (4.7) we confirm that
the solution is correct:
LHS of original equation = x – 3 = 13 – 3 = 10
This is equal to the RHS as required.
d
l Similarly, let us look at the equations
he
pu T 5y = 35 (4.8)
is
re ER
m
bl =5 (4.9)
2
In the first case, we shall divide both the sides by 5. This will give us just y on LHS
be NC
5y 5× y 35 5 × 7
New LHS = = =y, New RHS = = =7
5 5 5 5
Therefore, y=7
©
This is the required solution. We can substitute y = 7 in Eq. (4.8) and check that it is
satisfied.
In the second case, we shall multiply both sides by 2. This will give us just m on the
o
LHS
tt
m
The new LHS = × 2 = m. The new RHS = 5 × 2 = 10.
no
2
Hence, m = 10 (It is the required solution. You can check whether the solution is correct).
One can see that in the above examples, the operation we need to perform depends
on the equation. Our attempt should be to get the variable in the equation separated.
Sometimes, for doing so we may have to carry out more than one mathematical operation.
Let us solve some more equations with this in mind.
EXAMPLE 5 Solve: (a) 3n + 7 = 25 (4.10)
(b) 2p – 1 = 23 (4.11)
SOLUTION
(a) We go stepwise to separate the variable n on the LHS of the equation. The LHS is
3n + 7. We shall first subtract 7 from it so that we get 3n. From this, in the next step
we shall divide by 3 to get n. Remember we must do the same operation on both
sides of the equation. Therefore, subtracting 7 from both sides,
3n + 7 – 7 = 25 – 7 (Step 1)
or 3n = 18
2020-21
SIMPLE EQUATIONS 85
d
One good practice you should develop is to check the solution you have obtained.
he
Although we have not done this for (a) above, let us do it for this example.
pu T
Let us put the solution p = 12 back into the equation.
is
re ER
LHS = 2p – 1 = 2 × 12 – 1 = 24 – 1
bl
= 23 = RHS
be NC
Sarita, and Ameena and understand how they got their answers. For this purpose, let us
look at the equations (4.1) and (4.2) which correspond respectively to Ameena’s and
Appu’s examples.
o
tt
i.e. 4x = 60
4 x 60
Divide both sides by 4; this will separate x. We get =
4 4
or x = 15, which is the solution. (Check, if it is correct.)
l Now consider,10y – 20 = 50 (4.2)
Adding 20 to both sides, we get 10y – 20 + 20 = 50 + 20 or 10y = 70
10 y 70
Dividing both sides by 10, we get =
10 10
or y = 7, which is the solution. (Check if it is correct.)
You will realise that exactly these were the answers given by Appu, Sarita and Ameena.
They had learnt to set up equations and solve them. That is why they could construct their
mind reader game and impress the whole class. We shall come back to this in Section 4.7.
2020-21
86 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 4.2
1. Give first the step you will use to separate the variable and then solve the equation:
(a) x – 1 = 0 (b) x + 1 = 0 (c) x – 1 = 5 (d) x + 6 = 2
(e) y – 4 = – 7 (f) y – 4 = 4 (g) y + 4 = 4 (h) y + 4 = – 4
2. Give first the step you will use to separate the variable and then solve the equation:
b p
(a) 3l = 42 (b) =6 (c) =4 (d) 4x = 25
2 7
z 5 a 7
(e) 8y = 36 (f) = (g) = (h) 20t = – 10
3 4 5 15
3. Give the steps you will use to separate the variable and then solve the equation:
20 p 3p
(a) 3n – 2 = 46 (b) 5m + 7 = 17 (c) = 40 (d) =6
d
3 10
he
4. Solve the following equations:
pu T p –p
is
re ER
(a) 10p = 100 (b) 10p + 10 = 100 (c) =5 (d) =5
bl 4 3
3p
=6
be NC
2020-21
SIMPLE EQUATIONS 87
As we have seen, while solving equations one commonly used operation is adding or
subtracting the same number on both sides of the equation. Transposing a number
(i.e., changing the side of the number) is the same as adding or subtracting the number
from both sides. In doing so, the sign of the number has to be changed. What applies to
numbers also applies to expressions. Let us take two more examples of transposing.
Adding or Subtracting Transposing
on both sides
(i) 3p – 10 = 5 (i) 3p – 10 = 5
Add 10 to both sides Transpose (–10) from LHS to RHS
d
(ii) 5x + 12 = 27 (ii) 5x + 12 = 27
he
Subtract 12 from both sides Transposing + 12
pu T
(On transposing + 12 becomes – 12)
is
re ER
5x + 12 – 12 = 27 – 12 5x = 27 – 12
bl
or 5x = 15 or 5x = 15
be NC
We shall now solve two more equations. As you can see they involve brackets, which
have to be solved before proceeding.
EXAMPLE 7 Solve
©
(a) 4(m + 3) = 18
tt
Let us divide both the sides by 4. This will remove the brackets in the LHS We get,
no
18 9
m+3 = or m+3 =
4 2
9
or m = –3 (transposing 3 to RHS)
2
3 9 9 6 3
or m = (required solution) as − 3 = − =
2 2 2 2 2
Check
3 3
LHS = 4 + 3 = 4 × + 4 × 3 = 2 × 3 + 4 × 3 [put m = ]
3
2 2 2
= 6 + 12 = 18 = RHS
(b) –2(x + 3) = 8
We divide both sides by (– 2), so as to remove the brackets in the LHS, we get,
8
x+3=– or x + 3 = – 4
2
i.e., x = – 4 – 3 (transposing 3 to RHS) or x = –7 (required solution)
2020-21
88 MATHEMATICS
Check LHS = –2 ( –7 + 3) = –2 ( –4 )
= 8 = RHS as required.
d
TRY THESE
he
Multiply both sides by 4,
pu T 4x = 20 Divide both sides by 4.
Start with the same step
Subtract 3 from both sides, 4x – 3 = 17 Add 3 to both sides.
is
re ER
x = 5 and make two different bl
equations. Ask two of your This has resulted in an equation. If we follow the reverse path with each
classmates to solve the step, as shown on the right, we get the solution of the equation.
be NC
x =5
Multiply both sides by 3 3x = 15
o
Start with y = 4 and make two different equations. Ask three of your friends to do the
same. Are their equations different from yours?
no
Is it not nice that not only can you solve an equation, but you can make
equations? Further, did you notice that given an equation, you get one solution;
but given a solution, you can make many equations?
Now, Sara wants the class to know what she is thinking. She says, “I shall take Hetal’s
equation and put it into a statement form and that makes a puzzle. For example, think of a
number; multiply it by 3 and add 4 to the product. Tell me the sum you get.
If the sum is 19, the equation Hetal got will give us the solution to the
puzzle. In fact, we know it is 5, because Hetal started with it.”
TRY THESE She turns to Appu, Ameena and Sarita to check whether they made
Try to make two number their puzzle this way. All three say, “Yes!”
puzzles, one with the solution We now know how to create number puzzles and many other similar
11 and another with 100
problems.
2020-21
SIMPLE EQUATIONS 89
EXERCISE 4.3
1. Solve the following equations:
5 37 a q
(a) 2 y + = (b) 5t + 28 = 10 (c) +3= 2 (d) +7 =5
2 2 5 4
5 5 25 19
(e) x = –5 (f) x= (g) 7m + = 13 (h) 6z + 10 = –2
2 2 4 2
3l 2 2b
(i) = (j) –5=3
2 3 3
2. Solve the following equations:
(a) 2(x + 4) = 12 (b) 3(n – 5) = 21 (c) 3(n – 5) = – 21
d
(d) – 4(2 + x) = 8 (e) 4(2 – x) = 8
he
3. Solve the following equations:
pu T
is
re ER
(a) 4 = 5(p – 2) (b) – 4 = 5(p – 2)
bl (c) 16 = 4 + 3(t + 2)
(d) 4 + 5(p – 1) =34 (e) 0 = 16 + 4(m – 6)
be NC
We have already seen examples in which we have taken statements in everyday language
tt
and converted them into simple equations. We also have learnt how to solve simple equations.
Thus we are ready to solve puzzles/problems from practical situations. The method is first
no
to form equations corresponding to such situations and then to solve those equations
to give the solution to the puzzles/problems. We begin with what we have already seen
[Example 1 (i) and (iii), Section 4.2].
EXAMPLE 8 The sum of three times a number and 11 is 32. Find the number.
SOLUTION
l If the unknown number is taken to be x, then three times the number is 3x and the sum
of 3x and 11 is 32. That is, 3x + 11 = 32
This equation was obtained
l To solve this equation, we transpose 11 to RHS, so that
earlier in Section 4.2, Example 1.
3x = 32 – 11 or 3x = 21
Now, divide both sides by 3
21
So x= =7
3
2020-21
90 MATHEMATICS
The required number is 7. (We may check it by taking 3 times 7 and adding 11 to it.
It gives 32 as required.)
EXAMPLE 9 Find a number, such that one-fourth of the number is 3 more than 7.
SOLUTION
y
l Let us take the unknown number to be y; one-fourth of y is .
4
y
This number is more than 7 by 3.
4
y
Hence we get the equation for y as – 7 = 3
4
l To solve this equation, first transpose 7 to RHS We get,
d
TRY THESE
he
(i) When you multiply a y pu T
= 3 + 7 = 10.
number by 6 and subtract 4
is
re ER
5 from the product, you We then multiply both sides of the equation by 4, to get
bl
get 7. Can you tell what y
× 4 = 10 × 4 or y = 40 (the required number)
be NC
SOLUTION
no
TRY THESE
There are two types of boxes containing mangoes. Each box of the larger type contains
4 more mangoes than the number of mangoes contained in 8 boxes of the smaller type.
Each larger box contains 100 mangoes. Find the number of mangoes contained in the
smaller box?
2020-21
SIMPLE EQUATIONS 91
EXERCISE 4.4
1. Set up equations and solve them to find the unknown numbers in the following cases:
(a) Add 4 to eight times a number; you get 60.
(b) One-fifth of a number minus 4 gives 3.
(c) If I take three-fourths of a number and add 3 to it, I get 21.
(d) When I subtracted 11 from twice a number, the result was 15.
(e) Munna subtracts thrice the number of notebooks he has from 50, he finds the
result to be 8.
(f) Ibenhal thinks of a number. If she adds 19 to it and divides the sum by 5, she
will get 8.
5
(g) Anwar thinks of a number. If he takes away 7 from of the number, the
d
2
he
result is 23. pu T
2. Solve the following:
is
re ER
(a) The teacher tells the class that the highest marks obtained by a student in her
bl
class is twice the lowest marks plus 7. The highest score is 87. What is the
be NC
lowest score?
(b) In an isosceles triangle, the base angles are equal. The vertex angle is 40°.
What are the base angles of the triangle? (Remember, the sum of three angles of
a triangle is 180°).
©
(c) Sachin scored twice as many runs as Rahul. Together, their runs fell two short
of a double century. How many runs did each one score?
o
(i) Irfan says that he has 7 marbles more than five times the marbles Parmit has.
no
2020-21
92 MATHEMATICS
d
a series of identical mathematical operations on the two sides of the equation in such
he
a way that on one of the sides we get just the variable. The last step is the solution of
pu T
the equation.
is
re ER
6. Transposing means moving to the other side. Transposition of a number has the same
bl
effect as adding same number to (or subtracting the same number from) both sides of
be NC
the equation. When you transpose a number from one side of the equation to the
other side, you change its sign. For example, transposing +3 from the LHS to the
RHS in equation x + 3 = 8 gives x = 8 – 3 (= 5). We can carry out the transposition
©
8. We also learnt how, using the technique of doing the same mathematical operation
tt
(for example adding the same number) on both sides, we could build an equation
no
starting from its solution. Further, we also learnt that we could relate a given equation
to some appropriate practical situation and build a practical word problem/puzzle
from the equation.
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 93
Chapter 5
Lines and
Angles
d
5.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
You already know how to identify different lines, line segments and angles in a given
is
shape. Can you identify the different line segments and angles formed in the following
re ER
figures? (Fig 5.1) bl
be NC
©
Fig 5.1
tt
Can you also identify whether the angles made are acute or obtuse or right?
Recall that a line segment has two end points. If we extend the two end points in either
no
direction endlessly, we get a line. Thus, we can say that a line has no end points. On the other
hand, recall that a ray has one end point (namely its starting point). For example, look at the
figures given below:
(i) (ii)
(iii)
Fig 5.2
Here, Fig 5.2 (i) shows a line segment, Fig 5.2 (ii) shows a line and Fig 5.2 (iii) is that
of a ray. A line segment PQ is generally denoted by the symbol PQ , a line AB is denoted by
uuu
r
the symbol AB and the ray OP is denoted by OP . Give some examples of line segments and
rays from your daily life and discuss them with your friends.
2020-21
94 MATHEMATICS
Again recall that an angle is formed when lines or line segments meet. In Fig 5.1,
observe the corners. These corners are formed when two lines or line segments intersect
at a point. For example, look at the figures given below:
(i) (ii)
Fig 5.3
In Fig 5.3 (i) line segments AB and BC intersect at B to form angle ABC, and again
line segments BC and AC intersect at C to form angle ACB and so on. Whereas, in
d
Fig 5.3 (ii) lines PQ and RS intersect at O to form four angles POS,
TRY THESE
he
SOQ, QOR and ROP. An angle ABC is represented by the symbol
List ten figures around you
pu T
∠ABC. Thus, in Fig 5.3 (i), the three angles formed are ∠ABC, ∠BCA
is
re ER
and ∠BAC, and in Fig 5.3 (ii), the four angles formed are ∠POS, ∠SOQ,
and identify the acute, obtuse bl
∠QOR and ∠POR. You have already studied how to classify the angles
and right angles found in them.
as acute, obtuse or right angle.
be NC
Note: While referring to the measure of an angle ABC, we shall write m∠ABC as simply
∠ABC. The context will make it clear, whether we are referring to the angle or its measure.
©
When the sum of the measures of two angles is 90°, the angles are called complementary
tt
angles.
no
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 95
TRY THESE
1. Which pairs of following angles are complementary? (Fig 5.5)
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
(i) bl (ii)
be NC
©
(iii) (iv)
o
Fig 5.5
tt
(i) (ii)
2020-21
96 MATHEMATICS
Do you notice that the sum of the measures of the angles in each of the above pairs
(Fig 5.6) comes out to be 180º? Such pairs of angles are called supplementary angles.
d
When two angles are supplementary, each angle is said to be the supplement of the other.
he
pu T
THINK, DISCUSS AND WRITE
is
re ER
bl
1. Can two obtuse angles be supplementary?
be NC
TRY THESE
©
(i) (ii)
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 97
2. What will be the measure of the supplement of each one of the following angles?
(i) 100º (ii) 90º (iii) 55º (iv) 125º
3. Among two supplementary angles the measure of the larger angle is 44o more than
the measure of the smaller. Find their measures.
B
A
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
When you open a book it looks like the above Look at this steering wheel of a car. At the
figure. In A and B, we find a pair of angles, centre of the wheel you find three angles
placed next to each other. being formed, lying next to one another.
©
Fig 5.8
At both the vertices A and B, we find, a pair of angles are placed next to each other.
These angles are such that:
o
(iii) the non-common arms are on either side of the common arm.
Such pairs of angles are called adjacent angles. Adjacent angles have a common
vertex and a common arm but no common interior points.
TRY THESE
1. Are the angles marked 1 and 2 adjacent? (Fig 5.9). If they are not adjacent,
say, ‘why’.
2020-21
98 MATHEMATICS
(iv) (v)
Fig 5.9
d
he
THINK, DISCUSS
pu T AND WRITE
is
re ER
1. Can two adjacent angles be supplementary?
bl
2. Can two adjacent angles be complementary?
be NC
Are ∠1, ∠2 a linear pair? Yes Are ∠1, ∠2 a linear pair? No! (Why?)
(i) Fig 5.11 (ii)
In Fig 5.11 (i) above, observe that the opposite rays (which are the non-common
sides of ∠1 and ∠2) form a line. Thus, ∠1 + ∠2 amounts to 180o.
The angles in a linear pair are supplementary.
Have you noticed models of a linear pair in your environment?
Note carefully that a pair of supplementary angles form a linear pair when
placed adjacent to each other. Do you find examples of linear pair in your daily life?
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 99
THINK,
d
DISCUSS AND WRITE
he
1. Can two acute angles form a linear pair?
pu T
is
2. Can two obtuse angles form a linear pair?
re ER
3. Can two right angles form a linear pair?
bl
be NC
TRY THESE
Check which of the following pairs of angles form a linear pair (Fig 5.13):
©
o
tt
no
(i) (ii)
90°
80°
2020-21
100 MATHEMATICS
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
Fig 5.15
DO THIS
©
Draw two lines l and m, intersecting at a point. You can now mark ∠1, ∠2, ∠3 and
∠4 as in the Fig (5.16).
o
Place the copy on the original such that ∠1 matches with its copy, ∠2 matches with
no
Fig 5.16
You find that ∠1 and ∠3 have interchanged their positions and so have ∠2 and ∠4.
This has been done without disturbing the position of the lines.
Thus, ∠1 = ∠3 and ∠2 = ∠4.
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 101
We conclude that when two lines intersect, the vertically opposite angles so
formed are equal.
Let us try to prove this using Geometrical Idea.
Let us consider two lines l and m. (Fig 5.17)
We can arrive at this result through logical reasoning as follows:
Let l and m be two lines, which intersect at O,
making angles ∠1, ∠2, ∠3 and ∠4.
Fig 5.17
We want to prove that ∠1 = ∠3 and ∠2 = ∠4
Now, ∠1 = 180º – ∠2 (Because ∠1, ∠2 form a linear pair, so, ∠1 + ∠2 = 180o) (i)
Similarly, ∠3 = 180º – ∠2 (Since ∠2, ∠3 form a linear pair, so, ∠2 + ∠3 = 180o) (ii)
Therfore, ∠1 = ∠3 [By (i) and (ii)]
Similarly, we can prove that ∠2 = ∠4, (Try it!)
d
TRY THESE
he
1. In the given figure, if
pu T
is
re ER
∠1 = 30º, find ∠2 and ∠3. bl
2. Give an example for vertically opposite angles in
be NC
your surroundings.
(i) Five pairs of adjacent angles are (∠AOE, ∠EOC), (∠EOC, ∠COB),
(∠AOC, ∠COB), (∠COB, ∠BOD), (∠EOB, ∠BOD)
no
EXERCISE 5.1
1. Find the complement of each of the following angles:
2020-21
102 MATHEMATICS
d
4. Find the angle which is equal to its complement.
he
5. Find the angle which is equal to its supplement.
pu T
is
6. In the given figure, ∠1 and ∠2 are supplementary
re ER
angles. bl
If ∠1 is decreased, what changes should take place
be NC
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 103
12. Find the values of the angles x, y, and z in each of the following:
d
he
(i) pu T (ii)
is
re ER
13. Fill in the blanks:
bl
(i) If two angles are complementary, then the sum of their measures is _______.
be NC
(ii) If two angles are supplementary, then the sum of their measures is ______.
(iii) Two angles forming a linear pair are _______________.
(iv) If two adjacent angles are supplementary, they form a ___________.
©
(v) If two lines intersect at a point, then the vertically opposite angles are always
_____________.
(vi) If two lines intersect at a point, and if one pair of vertically opposite angles are
acute angles, then the other pair of vertically opposite angles are __________.
o
tt
Fig 5.19
2020-21
104 MATHEMATICS
The blackboard on its stand, the letter Y made up of line segments and the grill-door of
a window (Fig 5.19), what do all these have in common? They are examples of intersecting
lines.
Two lines l and m intersect if they have a point in common. This common point O is
their point of intersection.
d
segments in the figure?
he
pu T Fig 5.20
Can two lines intersect in more than one point? Think about it.
is
re ER
TRY THESE bl
be NC
1. Find examples from your surroundings where lines intersect at right angles.
2. Find the measures of the angles made by the intersecting lines at the vertices of an
equilateral triangle.
©
3. Draw any rectangle and find the measures of angles at the four vertices made by the
intersecting lines.
4. If two lines intersect, do they always intersect at right angles?
o
tt
5.3.2 Transversal
no
You might have seen a road crossing two or more roads or a railway line crossing several
other lines (Fig 5.21). These give an idea of a transversal.
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 105
d
In Fig 5.23 the line p is not a transversal, although it cuts two TRY THESE
he
lines l and m. Can you say, ‘why’? pu T 1. Suppose two lines are given.
5.3.3. Angles made by a Transversal
is
How many transversals can you
re ER
bl
In Fig 5.24, you see lines l and m cut by transversal p. The eight draw for these lines?
angles marked 1 to 8 have their special names: 2. If a line is a transversal to three
be NC
in your surroundings.
o
tt
no
Fig 5.24
2020-21
106 MATHEMATICS
(iii) are in ‘corresponding’ positions (above or below, left or right) relative to the
two lines.
Fig 5.25
d
(iii) lie ‘between’ the two lines.
he
pu T Fig 5.26
is
TRY THESE
re ER
bl
Name the pairs of angles in each figure:
be NC
©
o
tt
no
Fig 5.27
Transversals of parallel lines give rise to quite interesting results.
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 107
DO THIS
Take a ruled sheet of paper. Draw (in thick colour) two parallel lines l and m.
Draw a transversal t to the lines l and m. Label ∠1 and ∠2 as shown [Fig 5.28(i)].
Place a tracing paper over the figure drawn. Trace the lines l, m and t.
Slide the tracing paper along t, until l coincides with m.
You find that ∠1 on the traced figure coincides with ∠2 of the original figure.
In fact, you can see all the following results by similar tracing and sliding activity.
(i) ∠1 = ∠2 (ii) ∠3 = ∠4 (iii) ∠5 = ∠6 (iv) ∠7 = ∠8
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
(i) (ii)
©
o
tt
no
2020-21
108 MATHEMATICS
d
he
You can very easily remember these results if you can look for relevant ‘shapes’.
pu T
The F-shape stands for corresponding angles:
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
DO THIS
Draw a pair of parallel lines and a transversal. Verify the above three statements by actually
measuring the angles.
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 109
TRY THESE
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
If two lines are parallel, then you know that a transversal gives rise to
no
2020-21
110 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
EXERCISE 5.2
1. State the property that is used in each of the
o
following statements?
tt
2020-21
LINES AND ANGLES 111
(i) (ii)
5. In the given figure, the arms of two angles are parallel.
If ∠ABC = 70º, then find
(i) ∠DGC
d
(ii) ∠DEF
he
6. In the given figures below, decide whether l is parallel to m.
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
(ii) A ray has only one end point (its initial point); and
(iii) A line has no end points on either side.
2. An angle is formed when two lines (or rays or line-segments) meet.
Pairs of Angles Condition
Two complementary angles Measures add up to 90°
Two supplementary angles Measures add up to 180°
Two adjacent angles Have a common vertex and a common
arm but no common interior.
Linear pair Adjacent and supplementary
3. When two lines l and m meet, we say they intersect; the meeting point is called the
point of intersection.
When lines drawn on a sheet of paper do not meet, however far produced, we call
them to be parallel lines.
2020-21
112 MATHEMATICS
4. (i) When two lines intersect (looking like the letter X) we have two pairs of opposite
angles. They are called vertically opposite angles. They are equal in measure.
(ii) A transversal is a line that intersects two or more lines at distinct points.
(iii) A transversal gives rise to several types of angles.
(iv) In the figure, we have
Types of Angles Angles Shown
Interior ∠3, ∠4, ∠5, ∠6
Exterior ∠1, ∠2, ∠7, ∠8
Corresponding ∠1 and ∠5, ∠2 and ∠6,
∠3 and ∠7, ∠4 and ∠8
Alternate interior ∠3 and ∠6, ∠4 and ∠5
d
Alternate exterior ∠1 and ∠8, ∠2 and ∠7
he
pu T
Interior, on the same ∠3 and ∠5, ∠4 and ∠6
is
side of transversal
re ER
bl
(v) When a transversal cuts two parallel lines, we have the following interesting
relationships:
be NC
∠3 + ∠5 = 180°, ∠4 + ∠6 = 180°
tt
no
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 113
Chapter 6
The Triangle and
its Properties
d
6.1 INTRODUCTION
he
A triangle, you have seen, is a simple closed curve made of three line
is
segments. It has three vertices, three sides and three angles.
bl
Here is ∆ABC (Fig 6.1). It has
pu
be T
Vertices: A, B, C
The side opposite to the vertex A is BC. Can you name the angle opposite to the side AB?
no N
You know how to classify triangles based on the (i) sides (ii) angles.
(i) Based on Sides: Scalene, Isosceles and Equilateral triangles.
©
TRY THESE
1. Write the six elements (i.e., the 3 sides and the 3 angles) of ∆ABC.
2. Write the:
(i) Side opposite to the vertex Q of ∆PQR
(ii) Angle opposite to the side LM of ∆LMN
(iii) Vertex opposite to the side RT of ∆RST
3. Look at Fig 6.2 and classify each of the triangles according to its
(a) Sides
(b) Angles
2020-21
114 MATHEMATICS
P
L
cm
8cm
7cm
10
Q M N
6cm R 7cm
(ii) (iii)
d
he
Fig 6.2
is
bl
6.2 MEDIANS OF A TRIANGLE
pu
be T
Given a line segment, you know how to find its perpendicular bisector by paper folding.
o R
Cut out a triangle ABC from a piece of paper (Fig 6.3). Consider any one of its sides, say,
re
t t CE
A A
©
B C B C
D D
Fig 6.3
The line segment AD, joining the mid-point of BC to its opposite vertex A is called a
median of the triangle.
Consider the sides AB and CA and find two more medians of the triangle.
A median connects a vertex of a triangle to the mid-point of the opposite side.
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 115
A
6.3 ALTITUDES OF A TRIANGLE
Make a triangular shaped cardboard ABC. Place it upright on a
table. How ‘tall’ is the triangle? The height is the distance from B C
d
vertex, an altitude can be drawn. Fig 6.5
he
THINK, DISCUSS WRITE
is
AND
bl
1. How many altitudes can a triangle have?
pu
be T
2. Draw rough sketches of altitudes from A to BC for the following triangles (Fig 6.6):
A
o R
A A
re
t t CE
no N
B C B C B C
Acute-angled Right-angled Obtuse-angled
©
DO THIS
Take several cut-outs of
(i) an equilateral triangle (ii) an isosceles triangle and
(iii) a scalene triangle.
Find their altitudes and medians. Do you find anything special about them? Discuss it
with your friends.
2020-21
116 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 6.1
1. In ∆ PQR, D is the mid-point of QR .
P
PM is _________________.
PD is _________________.
Is QM = MR?
Q R
2. Draw rough sketches for the following: M D
(a) In ∆ABC, BE is a median.
(b) In ∆PQR, PQ and PR are altitudes of the triangle.
(c) In ∆XYZ, YL is an altitude in the exterior of the triangle.
3. Verify by drawing a diagram if the median and altitude of an isosceles triangle can be
d
same.
he
6.4 EXTERIOR ANGLE OF A TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTY
is
bl
DO THIS
pu
be T
Fig 6.7 remaining two angles of the triangle namely ∠A and ∠B are
called the two interior opposite angles or the two remote
interior angles of ∠ACD. Now cut out (or make trace copies of) ∠A and ∠B and
place them adjacent to each other as shown in Fig 6.8.
Do these two pieces together entirely cover ∠ACD?
Can you say that
m ∠ACD = m ∠A + m ∠B?
2. As done earlier, draw a triangle ABC and form an exterior angle ACD. Now take a
protractor and measure ∠ACD, ∠A
and ∠B.
Find the sum ∠A + ∠B and compare
it with the measure of ∠ACD. Do you
observe that ∠ACD is equal (or nearly
equal, if there is an error in
measurement) to ∠A + ∠B? Fig 6.8
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 117
You may repeat the two activities as mentioned by drawing some more triangles along
with their exterior angles. Every time, you will find that the exterior angle of a triangle is
equal to the sum of its two interior opposite angles.
A logical step-by-step argument can further confirm this fact.
An exterior angle of a triangle is equal to the sum of its interior opposite
angles.
Given: Consider ∆ABC.
∠ACD is an exterior angle.
To Show: m∠ACD = m∠A + m∠B
Through C draw CE , parallel to BA .
Fig 6.9
Justification
d
he
Steps Reasons
is
Therefore, alternate angles should be equal.
bl
pu
(b) ∠2 = ∠y BA || CE and BD is a transversal.
be T
o R
(c) ∠1 + ∠2 = ∠x + ∠y
t t CE
The above relation between an exterior angle and its two interior opposite angles is
referred to as the Exterior Angle Property of a triangle.
©
Fig 6.10
There are three more ways of getting exterior angles. Try to produce those rough
sketches.
2. Are the exterior angles formed at each vertex of a triangle equal?
3. What can you say about the sum of an exterior angle of a triangle and its adjacent
interior angle?
2020-21
118 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
d
1. An exterior angle of a triangle is of measure 70º and one of its interior opposite
he
angles is of measure 25º. Find the measure of the other interior opposite
is
angle.
2. The two interior opposite angles of an exterior angle of a triangle are 60º and
bl
80º. Find the measure of the exterior angle.
pu
be T
EXERCISE 6.2
no N
1. Find the value of the unknown exterior angle x in the following diagrams:
©
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 119
2. Find the value of the unknown interior angle x in the following figures:
d
he
is
6.5 ANGLE SUM PROPERTY bl OF A TRIANGLE
There is a remarkable property connecting the three angles of a triangle. You are going to
pu
see this through the following four activities.
be T
o R
1. Draw a triangle. Cut on the three angles. Rearrange them as shown in Fig 6.13 (i), (ii).
re
The three angles now constitute one angle. This angle is a straight angle and so has
t t CE
measure 180°.
no N
©
(i) (ii)
Fig 6.13
Thus, the sum of the measures of the three angles of a triangle is 180°.
2. The same fact you can observe in a different way also. Take three copies of any
triangle, say ∆ABC (Fig 6.14).
Fig 6.14
2020-21
120 MATHEMATICS
d
A C
B
he
B C
M M
(i) (ii) (iii)
is
bl Fig 6.16
You find that all the three angles form together a straight angle. This again shows that
pu
the sum of the measures of the three angles of a triangle is 180°.
be T
4. Draw any three triangles, say ∆ABC, ∆PQR and ∆XYZ in your notebook.
o R
re
Use your protractor and measure each of the angles of these triangles.
t t CE
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 121
d
= 180° – 99° = 81° Fig 6.18
he
EXERCISE 6.3
is
1. Find the value of the unknown x in the following diagrams:
bl
pu
be T
o R
re
t t CE
no N
©
2020-21
122 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
1. Two angles of a triangle are 30º and 80º. Find the third angle.
2. One of the angles of a triangle is 80º and the other two angles are equal. Find the
measure of each of the equal angles.
d
3. The three angles of a triangle are in the ratio 1:2:1. Find all the angles of the triangle.
he
Classify the triangle in two different ways.
5. Can you have a triangle with all the three angles equal to 60º?
6. Can you have a triangle with all the three angles less than 60º?
©
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 123
A triangle in which two sides are of equal lengths is called an isosceles triangle.
Fig 6.20
From a piece of paper cut out an isosceles triangle XYZ, with XY=XZ (Fig 6.20).
Fold it such that Z lies on Y. The line XM through X is now the axis of symmetry (which
you will read in Chapter 14). You find that ∠Y and ∠Z fit on each other exactly. XY and
XZ are called equal sides; YZ is called the base; ∠Y and ∠Z are called base angles and
these are also equal.
Thus, in an isosceles triangle:
d
he
(i) two sides have same length.
(ii) base angles opposite to the equal sides are equal.
is
TRY THESE
bl
pu
be T
2020-21
124 MATHEMATICS
d
mark the paths AB, BC and AC.
he
Ask your friend to start from A and reach C, walking along one or
more of these paths. She can, for example, walk first along AB and then
is
bl
along BC to reach C; or she can walk straight along AC . She will naturally
pu
prefer the direct path AC. If she takes the other path ( AB and then BC ),
be T
Fig 6.21
re
AB + BC > AC (i)
t t CE
Similarly, if one were to start from B and go to A, he or she will not take the route
BC and CA but will prefer BA This is because
no N
BC + CA > AB (ii)
By a similar argument, you find that
©
CA + AB > BC (iii)
These observations suggest that the sum of the lengths of any two sides of a
triangle is greater than the third side.
2. Collect fifteen small sticks (or strips) of different lengths, say, 6 cm, 7 cm, 8 cm,
9 cm, ..., 20 cm.
Take any three of these sticks and try to form a triangle. Repeat this by choosing
different combinations of three sticks.
Suppose you first choose two sticks of length 6 cm and 12 cm. Your third stick has to
be of length more than 12 – 6 = 6 cm and less than 12 + 6 = 18 cm. Try this and find
out why it is so.
To form a triangle you will need any three sticks such that the sum of the lengths of
any two of them will always be greater than the length of the third stick.
This also suggests that the sum of the lengths of any two sides of a triangle is greater
than the third side.
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 125
3. Draw any three triangles, say ∆ABC, ∆PQR and ∆XYZ in your notebook
(Fig 6.22).
A R
B C P Q
(i) (ii) (iii)
Fig 6.22
Use your ruler to find the lengths of their sides and then tabulate your results as follows:
d
he
∆ ABC AB ___ AB – BC < CA (Yes/No)
___ + ___ > ___
is
BC ___ bl BC – CA < AB (Yes/No)
___ + ___ > ___
pu
be T
This also strengthens our earlier guess. Therefore, we conclude that sum of the lengths
of any two sides of a triangle is greater than the length of the third side.
We also find that the difference between the length of any two sides of a triangle is
smaller than the length of the third side.
2020-21
126 MATHEMATICS
EXAMPLE 3 Is there a triangle whose sides have lengths 10.2 cm, 5.8 cm and 4.5 cm?
SOLUTION Suppose such a triangle is possible. Then the sum of the lengths of any two
sides would be greater than the length of the third side. Let us check this.
Is 4.5 + 5.8 >10.2? Yes
Is 5.8 + 10.2 > 4.5? Yes
Is 10.2 + 4.5 > 5.8? Yes
Therefore, the triangle is possible.
EXAMPLE 4 The lengths of two sides of a triangle are 6 cm and 8 cm. Between which
two numbers can length of the third side fall?
SOLUTION We know that the sum of two sides of a triangle is always greater than
d
the third.
he
Therefore, third side has to be less than the sum of the two sides. The third side is thus,
less than 8 + 6 = 14 cm.
is
The side cannot be less than the difference of the two sides. Thus, the third side has to
bl
be more than 8 – 6 = 2 cm.
pu
be T
The length of the third side could be any length greater than 2 and less than 14 cm.
o R
re
EXERCISE 6.4
t t CE
R
2. Take any point O in the interior of a triangle PQR. Is
(i) OP + OQ > PQ? O
P Q
(ii) OQ + OR > QR? A
(iii) OR + OP > RP?
3. AM is a median of a triangle ABC.
Is AB + BC + CA > 2 AM? B C
M
(Consider the sides of triangles
∆ABM and ∆AMC.)
4. ABCD is a quadrilateral.
Is AB + BC + CD + DA > AC + BD?
5. ABCD is quadrilateral. Is
AB + BC + CD + DA < 2 (AC + BD)?
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 127
6. The lengths of two sides of a triangle are 12 cm and 15 cm. Between what two
measures should the length of the third side fall?
d
countries too. The Indian mathematician Baudhayan
he
has also given an equivalent form of this property.
We now try to explain the Pythagoras property. Fig 6.23
is
In a right-angled triangle, the sides have some
bl
special names. The side opposite to the right angle
is called the hypotenuse; the other two sides are
pu
be T
2020-21
128 MATHEMATICS
The squares are identical; the eight triangles inserted are also identical.
Hence the uncovered area of square A = Uncovered area of square B.
i.e., Area of inner square of square A = The total area of two uncovered squares in square B.
a2 = b2 + c2
This is Pythagoras property. It may be stated as follows:
In a right-angled triangle,
the square on the hypotenuse = sum of the squares on the legs.
d
equal to the sum of the areas of the squares on the legs.
he
Draw a right triangle, preferably on
a square sheet, construct squares on
is
its sides, compute the area of these
bl
squares and verify the theorem
practically (Fig 6.26).
pu
be T
DO THIS
1. Have cut-outs of squares with sides 4 cm,
5 cm, 6 cm long. Arrange to get a triangular
shape by placing the corners of the squares 62
suitably as shown in the figure (Fig 6.27). 52 5 6
Trace out the triangle formed. Measure each
angle of the triangle. You find that there is no 4
right angle at all. 42
In fact, in this case each angle will be acute! Note
that 42 + 52 ≠ 62, 52 + 62 ≠ 42 and 62 + 42 ≠ 52. Fig 6.27
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 129
2. Repeat the above activity with squares whose sides have lengths 4 cm, 5 cm and
7 cm. You get an obtuse-angled triangle! Note that
42 + 52 ≠ 72 etc.
This shows that Pythagoras property holds if and only if the triangle is right-angled.
Hence we get this fact:
EXAMPLE 5 Determine whether the triangle whose lengths of sides are 3 cm, 4 cm,
5 cm is a right-angled triangle.
SOLUTION 32 = 3 × 3 = 9; 42 = 4 × 4 = 16; 52 = 5 × 5 = 25
d
We find 32 + 42 = 52.
he
Therefore, the triangle is right-angled.
is
Note: In any right-angled triangle, the hypotenuse happens to be the longest side. In this
bl
example, the side with length 5 cm is the hypotenuse.
pu
be T
AC = 5 cm and BC = 12 cm find
t t CE
TRY THESE
Find the unknown length x in the following figures (Fig 6.29):
2020-21
130 MATHEMATICS
24 37 37
12
7
x x
(iv) (v)
Fig 6.29
EXERCISE 6.5
d
2. ABC is a triangle, right-angled at C. If AB = 25
he
cm and AC = 7 cm, find BC.
is
3. A 15 m long ladder reached a window 12 m high
bl
from the ground on placing it against a wall at a
distance a. Find the distance of the foot of the
pu
be T
triangle?
(i) 2.5 cm,6.5 cm, 6 cm.
no N
2020-21
THE TRIANGLE AND ITS PROPERTIES 131
DO THIS
Enrichment activity
There are many proofs for Pythagoras theorem, using ‘dissection’ and ‘rearrangement’
d
procedure. Try to collect a few of them and draw charts explaining them.
he
is
WHAT HAVE
bl WE DISCUSSED?
1. The six elements of a triangle are its three angles and the three sides.
pu
be T
2. The line segment joining a vertex of a triangle to the mid point of its opposite side is
o R
3. The perpendicular line segment from a vertex of a triangle to its opposite side is
called an altitude of the triangle. A triangle has 3 altitudes.
4. An exterior angle of a triangle is formed, when a side of a triangle is produced. At
no N
The measure of any exterior angle of a triangle is equal to the sum of the measures of
its interior opposite angles.
6. The angle sum property of a triangle:
The total measure of the three angles of a triangle is 180°.
7. A triangle is said to be equilateral, if each one of its sides has the same length.
In an equilateral triangle, each angle has measure 60°.
8. A triangle is said to be isosceles, if atleast any two of its sides are of same length.
The non-equal side of an isosceles triangle is called its base; the base angles of an
isosceles triangle have equal measure.
9. Property of the lengths of sides of a triangle:
The sum of the lengths of any two sides of a triangle is greater than the length of the
third side.
The difference between the lengths of any two sides is smaller than the length of the
third side.
2020-21
132 MATHEMATICS
This property is useful to know if it is possible to draw a triangle when the lengths of
the three sides are known.
10. In a right angled triangle, the side opposite to the right angle is called the hypotenuse
and the other two sides are called its legs.
11. Pythagoras property:
In a right-angled triangle,
the square on the hypotenuse = the sum of the squares on its legs.
If a triangle is not right-angled, this property does not hold good. This property is
useful to decide whether a given triangle is right-angled or not.
d
he
is
bl
pu
be T
o R
re
t t CE
no N
©
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 133
Chapter 7
Congruence of
Triangles
d
7.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
You are now ready to learn a very important geometrical idea, Congruence. In particular,
you will study a lot about congruence of triangles.
is
re ER
To understand what congruence is, we turn to some activities.
bl
be NC
DO THIS
Take two stamps (Fig 7.1) of same denomination. Place one stamp over
the other. What do you observe?
©
o
tt
Fig 7.1
no
One stamp covers the other completely and exactly. This means that the two stamps are
of the same shape and same size. Such objects are said to be congruent. The two stamps
used by you are congruent to one another. Congruent objects are exact copies of one
another.
Can you, now, say if the following objects are congruent or not?
1. Shaving blades of the same company [Fig 7.2 (i)].
2. Sheets of the same letter-pad [Fig 7.2 (ii)]. 3. Biscuits in the same packet [Fig 7.2 (iii)].
4. Toys made of the same mould. [Fig 7.2(iv)]
2020-21
134 MATHEMATICS
The relation of two objects being congruent is called congruence. For the present,
we will deal with plane figures only, although congruence is a general idea applicable to
three-dimensional shapes also. We will try to learn a precise meaning of the congruence
of plane figures already known.
d
(i) (ii)
he
pu T Fig 7.3
You can use the method of superposition. Take a trace-copy of one of them and place
is
re ER
it over the other. If the figures cover each other completely, they are congruent. Alternatively,
bl
you may cut out one of them and place it over the other. Beware! You are not allowed to
be NC
bend, twist or stretch the figure that is cut out (or traced out).
In Fig 7.3, if figure F1 is congruent to figure F2 , we write F1 ≅ F2.
When are two line segments congruent? Observe the two pairs of line segments given
here (Fig 7.4).
o
tt
no
(i) (ii)
Fig 7.4
Use the ‘trace-copy’ superposition method for the pair of line segments in [Fig 7.4(i)].
Copy CD and place it on AB . You find that CD covers AB , with C on A and D on B.
Hence, the line segments are congruent. We write AB ≅ CD .
Repeat this activity for the pair of line segments in [Fig 7.4(ii)]. What do you find?
They are not congruent. How do you know it? It is because the line segments do not
coincide when placed one over other.
You should have by now noticed that the pair of line segments in [Fig 7.4(i)] matched
with each other because they had same length; and this was not the case in [Fig 7.4(ii)].
If two line segments have the same (i.e., equal) length, they are congruent. Also,
if two line segments are congruent, they have the same length.
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 135
In view of the above fact, when two line segments are congruent, we sometimes just
say that the line segments are equal; and we also write AB = CD. (What we actually mean
is AB ≅ CD ).
d
he
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
pu T
Fig 7.5
is
re ER
Make a trace-copy of ∠PQR. Try to superpose it on ∠ABC. For this, first place
bl
uuur uuur uuur
Q on B and QP along BA . Where does QR fall? It falls on BC .
be NC
(Note that the measurement of these two congruent angles are same).
We write ∠ABC ≅ ∠PQR (i)
or m∠ABC = m ∠PQR(In this case, measure is 40°).
o
tt
Now,
uuur you take
uuura trace-copy
uuuur of ∠LMN. Try to superpose it on ∠ABC. Place M on B
uuur
and ML along BA . Does MN fall on BC ? No, in this case it does not happen. You find
no
that ∠ABC and ∠LMN do not cover each other exactly. So, they are not congruent.
(Note that, in this case, the measures of ∠ABC and ∠LMN are not equal).
uuur uuur
What about angles ∠XYZ and u∠ABC?uur The rays YX and YZ , respectively appear
uuur
[in Fig 7.5 (iv)] to be longer than BA and BC . You may, hence, think that ∠ABC is
‘smaller’ than ∠XYZ. But remember that the rays in the figure only indicate the direction
and not any length. On superposition, you will find that these two angles are also congruent.
We write ∠ABC ≅ ∠XYZ (ii)
or m∠ABC = m∠XYZ
In view of (i) and (ii), we may even write
∠ABC ≅ ∠PQR ≅ ∠XYZ
If two angles have the same measure, they are congruent. Also, if two angles are
congruent, their measures are same.
2020-21
136 MATHEMATICS
As in the case of line segments, congruency of angles entirely depends on the equality
of their measures. So, to say that two angles are congruent, we sometimes just say that the
angles are equal; and we write
∠ABC = ∠PQR (to mean ∠ABC ≅ ∠PQR).
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
B
bl C
be NC
(i) (ii)
Fig 7.6
∆ABC and ∆PQR have the same size and shape. They are congruent. So, we would
express this as
©
∆ABC ≅ ∆PQR
This means that, when you place ∆PQR on ∆ABC, P falls on A, Q falls on B and R
o
falls on C, also falls along AB , QR falls along BC and PR falls along AC . If, under
tt
a given correspondence, two triangles are congruent, then their corresponding parts
no
(i.e., angles and sides) that match one another are equal. Thus, in these two congruent
triangles, we have:
Corresponding vertices : A and P, B and Q, C and R.
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 137
d
Fig 7.7
he
The correspondence is ABC ↔ RQP. This means
pu T
A↔R ; B ↔ Q; and C ↔ P.
is
re ER
So, (i) PQ ↔ CB
bl
(ii) ∠Q ↔ ∠B and (iii) RP ↔ AC
be NC
Find the other four correspondences by using two cutouts of triangles. Will all
tt
EXERCISE 7.1
1. Complete the following statements:
(a) Two line segments are congruent if ___________.
(b) Among two congruent angles, one has a measure of 70°; the measure of
the other angle is ___________.
(c) When we write ∠A = ∠B, we actually mean ___________.
2. Give any two real-life examples for congruent shapes.
3. If ∆ABC ≅ ∆FED under the correspondence ABC ↔ FED, write all the
corresponding congruent parts of the triangles.
4. If ∆DEF ≅ ∆BCA, write the part(s) of ∆BCA that correspond to
(i) ∠E (ii) EF (iii) ∠F (iv) DF
2020-21
138 MATHEMATICS
d
he
Fig 7.8 SSS Game pu T
Triangle drawn by Appu : One side of ∆ABC is 5.5 cm.
is
re ER
Appu Tippu : With this information, I can draw any number of triangles (Fig 7.9)
bl
but they need not be copies of ∆ABC. The triangle I draw may be
be NC
Fig 7.9
tt
I have used some arbitrary lengths for other sides. This gives me many triangles with
no
Fig 7.10
One cannot draw an exact copy of your triangle, if only the lengths of two sides
are given.
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 139
Appu : Alright. Let me give the lengths of all the three sides. In ∆ABC, I have AB = 5cm,
BC = 5.5 cm and AC = 3.4 cm.
Tippu : I think it should be possible. Let me try now.
First I draw a rough figure so that I can remember the lengths easily.
d
Appu : Excellent. So, to draw a copy of a given ∆ABC (i.e., to draw a triangle
he
congruent to ∆ABC), we need the lengths of three sides. Shall we call this condition
as side-side-side criterion? pu T
is
re ER
Tippu : Why not we call it SSS criterion, to be short?
bl
SSS Congruence criterion:
be NC
If under a given correspondence, the three sides of one triangle are equal to the three
corresponding sides of another triangle, then the triangles are congruent.
©
cm
of the other triangle. So, by SSS congruence rule, the two triangles are
cm
congruent. From the above three equality relations, it can be easily seen
that A ↔ R, B ↔ P and C ↔ Q. R
So, we have ∆ABC ≅ ∆RPQ Fig 7.12
Important note: The order of the letters in the names of congruent triangles displays the
corresponding relationships. Thus, when you write ∆ABC ≅ ∆RPQ, you would know
that A lies on R, B on P, C on Q, AB along RP , BC along PQ and AC along RQ .
2020-21
140 MATHEMATICS
d
he
So, BD bisects ∠ABC.
pu T
is
re ER
TRY THESE bl
1. In Fig 7.14, lengths of the sides of the triangles are indicated. By applying the SSS
be NC
congruence rule, state which pairs of triangles are congruent. In case of congruent
triangles, write the result in symbolic form:
©
o
tt
no
(i)
(ii)
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 141
A
2. In Fig 7.15, AB = AC and D is the mid-point of BC .
(i) State the three pairs of equal parts in
∆ADB and ∆ADC.
(ii) Is ∆ADB ≅ ∆ADC? Give reasons.
D C
(iii) Is ∠B = ∠C? Why?
3. In Fig 7.16, AC = BD and AD = BC. Which B D
C
of the following statements is meaningfully written? Fig 7.15
(i) ∆ABC ≅ ∆ABD (ii) ∆ABC ≅ ∆BAD. A B
Fig 7.16
d
ABC is an isosceles triangle with AB = AC (Fig 7.17). A
he
pu T
Take a trace-copy of ∆ABC and also name it as ∆ABC.
is
re ER
(i) State the three pairs of equal parts in ∆ABC and ∆ACB.
(ii) Is ∆ABC ≅ ∆ACB? Why or why not?
bl B C
be NC
Tippu : This again is not sufficient for the job. I can find many triangles satisfying your
information, but are not copies of ∆ABC. For example, I have given here some of them
(Fig 7.18):
Fig 7.18
2020-21
142 MATHEMATICS
65°
d
B C B C
he
5.5 cm 5.5 cm
(i)
pu T (ii) (iii)
is
re ER
bl Fig 7.19
Yes, I got it, A must be 3.4 cm away from C along this angular line through C.
be NC
If under a correspondence, two sides and the angle included between them of a triangle
are equal to two corresponding sides and the angle included between them of another
triangle, then the triangles are congruent.
EXAMPLE 4 Given below are measurements of some parts of two triangles. Examine
whether the two triangles are congruent or not, by using SAS congruence
rule. If the triangles are congruent, write them in symbolic form.
∆ABC ∆DEF
(a) AB = 7 cm, BC = 5 cm, ∠B = 50° DE = 5 cm, EF = 7 cm, ∠E = 50°
(b) AB = 4.5 cm, AC = 4 cm, ∠A = 60° DE = 4 cm, FD = 4.5 cm, ∠D = 55°
(c) BC = 6 cm, AC = 4 cm, ∠B = 35° DF = 4 cm, EF = 6 cm, ∠E = 35°
(It will be always helpful to draw a rough figure, mark the measurements and then
probe the question).
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 143
SOLUTION
(a) Here, AB = EF ( = 7 cm), BC = DE ( = 5 cm) and
included ∠B = included ∠E ( = 50°). Also, A ↔ F B ↔ E and C ↔ D.
Therefore, ∆ABC ≅ ∆FED (By SAS congruence rule) (Fig 7.20)
A
D A
60°
m
m
m
5c
7c
c
4.5
50° 50°
B C E 7 cm
F B C
5 cm
Fig 7.20 Fig 7.21
d
he
(b) Here, AB = FD and AC = DE (Fig 7.21).
pu T
But included ∠A ≠ included ∠D. So, we cannot say that the triangles are
is
re ER
congruent. bl
(c) Here, BC = EF, AC = DF and ∠B = ∠E.
be NC
But ∠B is not the included angle between the sides AC and BC.
Similarly, ∠E is not the included angle between the sides EF and DF. D
4c
So, SAS congruence rule cannot be applied and we cannot conclude m
©
Fig 7.22
(i) State three pairs of equal parts in triangles ADB and ADC.
tt
A
(ii) Is ∆ADB ≅ ∆ADC? Give reasons.
no
TRY THESE
1. Which angle is included between the sides DE and EF of ∆DEF?
2. By applying SAS congruence rule, you want to establish that ∆PQR ≅ ∆FED. It is
given that PQ = FE and RP = DF. What additional information is needed to establish
the congruence?
2020-21
144 MATHEMATICS
3. In Fig 7.24, measures of some parts of the triangles are indicated. By applying SAS
congruence rule, state the pairs of congruent triangles, if any, in each case. In case
of congruent triangles, write them in symbolic form.
(ii)
(i)
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
(iii) bl Fig 7.24 (iv)
be NC
ASA Game
Can you draw Appu’s triangle, if you know
(i) only one of its angles? (ii) only two of its angles?
(iii) two angles and any one side?
(iv) two angles and the side included between them?
Attempts to solve the above questions lead us to the following criterion:
ASA Congruence criterion:
If under a correspondence, two angles and the included side of a triangle are equal to
two corresponding angles and the included side of another triangle, then the triangles
are congruent.
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 145
SOLUTION For ASA congruence rule, we need the two angles between which the
two sides BC and RP are included. So, the additional information is
as follows:
∠B = ∠R
and ∠C = ∠P
d
(using angle sum property of a triangle)
he
Similarly, ∠B of ∆BOD = 180° – (70° + 30°) = 80°
Thus, we have
pu T
∠A = ∠B, AC = BD and ∠C = ∠D
is
re ER
Now, side AC is between ∠A and ∠C and side BD is between ∠B and ∠D.
bl
So, by ASA congruence rule, ∆AOC ≅ ∆BOD.
be NC
Remark
Given two angles of a triangle, you can always find the third angle of the triangle. So,
whenever, two angles and one side of one triangle are equal to the corresponding two
©
angles and one side of another triangle, you may convert it into ‘two angles and the included
side’ form of congruence and then apply the ASA congruence rule.
o
TRY THESE
tt
2. You want to establish ∆DEF ≅ ∆MNP, using the ASA congruence rule. You are
given that ∠D = ∠M and ∠F = ∠P. What information is needed to establish the
congruence? (Draw a rough figure and then try!)
3. In Fig 7.27, measures of some parts are indicated. By applying ASA congruence
rule, state which pairs of triangles are congruent. In case of congruence, write the
result in symoblic form.
(i) (ii)
2020-21
146 MATHEMATICS
D C
45° 45°
30° 30° B
A
(iii) (iv)
Fig 7.27
4. Given below are measurements of some parts of two triangles. Examine whether the
two triangles are congruent or not, by ASA congruence rule. In case of congruence,
write it in symbolic form.
∆ DEF ∆ PQR
(i) ∠D = 60º, ∠F = 80º, DF = 5 cm ∠Q = 60º, ∠R = 80º, QR = 5 cm
d
(ii) ∠D = 60º, ∠F = 80º, DF = 6 cm ∠Q = 60º, ∠R = 80º, QP = 6 cm
he
(iii) ∠E = 80º, ∠F = 30º, EF = 5 cm ∠P = 80º, PQ = 5 cm, ∠R = 30º
pu T
5. In Fig 7.28, ray AZ bisects ∠DAB as well as
is
re ER
∠DCB. bl
(i) State the three pairs of equal parts in
be NC
Congruence in the case of two right triangles deserves special attention. In such triangles,
obviously, the right angles are equal. So, the congruence criterion becomes easy.
no
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 147
EXAMPLE 8 Given below are measurements of some parts of two triangles. Examine
whether the two triangles are congruent or not, using RHS congruence
rule. In case of congruent triangles, write the result in symbolic form:
∆ ABC ∆ PQR
(i) ∠B = 90°, AC = 8 cm, AB = 3 cm ∠P = 90°, PR = 3 cm, QR = 8 cm
(ii) ∠A = 90°, AC = 5 cm, BC = 9 cm ∠Q = 90°, PR = 8 cm, PQ = 5 cm
SOLUTION
(i) Here, ∠B = ∠P = 90º,
hypotenuse, AC = hypotenuse, RQ (= 8 cm) and
side AB = side RP ( = 3 cm)
So, ∆ABC ≅ ∆RPQ (By RHS Congruence rule). [Fig 7.30(i)]
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
2020-21
148 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
1. In Fig 7.32, measures of some parts of triangles are given.By applying RHS
congruence rule, state which pairs of triangles are congruent. In case of congruent
triangles, write the result in symbolic form.
(i) (ii)
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
(iii) (iv)
Fig 7.32
2. It is to be established by RHS congruence rule that ∆ABC ≅ ∆RPQ.
o
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 149
We now turn to examples and problems based on the criteria seen so far.
EXERCISE 7.2
1. Which congruence criterion do you use in the following?
A D
(a) Given: AC = DF
AB = DE
BC = EF B C E F
d
RQ = ZY
he
∠PRQ = ∠XZY pu T Q Y
P X
is
re ER
So, ∆PQR ≅ ∆XYZ bl
(c) Given: ∠MLN = ∠FGH L H
be NC
∠NML = ∠GFH N
F
ML = FG
M G
©
AE = BC
tt
∠A = ∠C = 90°
no
A B C
So, ∆ABE ≅ ∆CDB
2. You want to show that ∆ART ≅ ∆PEN,
(a) If you have to use SSS criterion, then you need to show
2020-21
150 MATHEMATICS
d
congruence criterion. Is he justified? Why or
he
why not? pu T A T
is
re ER
5. In the figure, the two triangles are congruent.
bl
The corresponding parts are marked. We can N O
write ∆RAT ≅ ?
be NC
∆BCA ≅ ? ∆QRS ≅ ?
7. In a squared sheet, draw two triangles of equal areas such that
(i) the triangles are congruent.
(ii) the triangles are not congruent.
What can you say about their perimeters?
8. Draw a rough sketch of two triangles such
that they have five pairs of congruent parts
but still the triangles are not congruent.
9. If ∆ABC and ∆PQR are to be congruent,
name one additional pair of corresponding
parts. What criterion did you use?
2020-21
CONGRUENCE OF TRIANGLES 151
Enrichment activity B C F
We saw that superposition is a useful method to test congruence of plane figures. We
discussed conditions for congruence of line segments, angles and triangles. You can now
try to extend this idea to other plane figures as well.
1. Consider cut-outs of different sizes of squares. Use the method of superposition to
find out the condition for congruence of squares. How does the idea of
‘corresponding parts’ under congruence apply? Are there corresponding sides? Are
there corresponding diagonals?
d
2. What happens if you take circles? What is the condition for congruence of two
he
circles? Again, you can use the method of superposition. Investigate.
pu T
is
re ER
3. Try to extend this idea to other plane figures like regular hexagons, etc.
bl
4. Take two congruent copies of a triangle. By paper folding, investigate if they have
be NC
equal altitudes. Do they have equal medians? What can you say about their perimeters
and areas?
WHAT WE DISCUSSED?
©
HAVE
1. Congruent objects are exact copies of one another.
2. The method of superposition examines the congruence of plane figures.
o
tt
3. Two plane figures, say, F1 and F2 are congruent if the trace-copy of F1 fits exactly on
that of F2. We write this as F1 ≅ F2.
no
4. Two line segments, say, AB and CD , are congruent if they have equal lengths. We
write this as AB ≅ CD . However, it is common to write it as AB = CD .
5. Two angles, say, ∠ABC and ∠PQR, are congruent if their measures are equal. We
write this as ∠ABC ≅ ∠PQR or as m∠ABC = m∠PQR. However, in practice, it is
common to write it as ∠ABC = ∠PQR.
6. SSS Congruence of two triangles:
Under a given correspondence, two triangles are congruent if the three sides of the
one are equal to the three corresponding sides of the other.
7. SAS Congruence of two triangles:
Under a given correspondence, two triangles are congruent if two sides and the angle
included between them in one of the triangles are equal to the corresponding sides and
the angle included between them of the other triangle.
2020-21
152 MATHEMATICS
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
no
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 153
Chapter 8
Comparing
Quantities
d
8.1 INTRODUCTION 150
he
pu T
In our daily life, there are many occasions when we compare two quantities.
is
re ER
Suppose we are comparing heights of Heena and Amir. We find that
bl
1. Heena is two times taller than Amir. 75
be NC
Or
1
2. Amir’s height is of Heena’s height.
2
©
Consider another example, where 20 marbles are divided between Rita and 150 cm 75 cm
Amit such that Rita has 12 marbles and Heena Amir
Amit has 8 marbles. We say,
o
3
tt
Or
2
2. Amit has part of what Rita has.
3
Yet another example is where we compare
speeds of a Cheetah and a Man.
The speed of a Cheetah is 6 times the speed
of a Man.
Or
1
The speed of a Man is of the speed of Speed of Cheetah Speed of Man
6
the Cheetah. 120 km per hour 20 km per hour
Do you remember comparisons like this? In Class VI, we have learnt to make comparisons
by saying how many times one quantity is of the other. Here, we see that it can also be
inverted and written as what part one quantity is of the other.
2020-21
154 MATHEMATICS
d
EXAMPLE 1 Find the ratio of 3 km to 300 m.
he
SOLUTION First convert both the distances to the same unit.
pu T
is
re ER
So, 3 km = 3 × 1000 m = 3000 m.
Thus,
bl
the required ratio, 3 km : 300 m is 3000 : 300 = 10 : 1.
be NC
or not. To do this, we need to write the ratios in the form of fractions and then compare
them by converting them to like fractions. If these like fractions are equal, we say the given
ratios are equivalent.
o
1 2
SOLUTION To check this, we need to know whether = .
no
2 3
1 1× 3 3 2 2 × 2 4
We have, = = ; = =
2 2×3 6 3 3× 2 6
3 4 1 2
We find that < , which means that < .
6 6 2 3
Therefore, the ratio 1:2 is not equivalent to the ratio 2:3.
Use of such comparisons can be seen by the following example.
EXAMPLE 3 Following is the performance of a cricket team in the matches it played:
Year Wins Losses
Last year 8 2 In which year was the record better?
This year 4 2 How can you say so?
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 155
d
Can you say what is wrong? How can you say this?
he
pu T
In this case, the ratio of heights in the drawing should be the same as the
is
re ER
ratio of actual heights. That is
Actual height of building
bl
Height of building in drawing
= .
be NC
Another example where proportions are used is in the making of national flags.
Do you know that the flags are always made in a fixed ratio of length to its breadth?
These may be different for different countries but are mostly around 1.5 : 1 or 1.7 : 1.
o
We can take an approximate value of this ratio as 3 : 2. Even the Indian post card is
tt
Now, can you say whether a card with length 4.5 cm and breadth 3.0 cm
is near to this ratio. That is we need to ask, is 4.5 : 3.0 equivalent to 3 : 2?
4.5 45 3
We note that 4.5 : 3.0 = = =
3.0 30 2
Hence, we see that 4.5 : 3.0 is equivalent to 3 : 2.
We see a wide use of such proportions in real life. Can you think of some more
situations?
We have also learnt a method in the earlier classes known as Unitary Method in
which we first find the value of one unit and then the value of the required number of units.
Let us see how both the above methods help us to achieve the same thing.
EXAMPLE 4 A map is given with a scale of 2 cm = 1000 km. What is the actual distance
between the two places in kms, if the distance in the map is 2.5 cm?
2020-21
156 MATHEMATICS
SOLUTION
Arun does it like this Meera does it like this
Let distance = x km 2 cm means 1000 km.
1000
then, 1000 : x = 2 : 2.5 So, 1 cm means km
2
1000 2 1000
= Hence, 2.5 cm means × 2.5 km
x 2. 5 2
1000× x × 2.5 2
= × x × 2.5 = 1250 km
x 2.5
1000 × 2.5 = x × 2
d
x = 1250
he
Arun has solved it by equating ratios to make proportions and then by solving the
pu T
equation. Meera has first found the distance that corresponds to 1 cm and then used that to
is
re ER
find what 2.5 cm would correspond to. She used the unitary method.
bl
Let us solve some more examples using the unitary method.
be NC
EXAMPLE 5 6 bowls cost ` 90. What would be the cost of 10 such bowls?
SOLUTION Cost of 6 bowls is ` 90.
©
90
Therefore, cost of 1 bowl = `
6
90
o
EXAMPLE 6 The car that I own can go 150 km with 25 litres of petrol. How far can
it go with 30 litres of petrol?
SOLUTION With 25 litres of petrol, the car goes 150 km.
150
With 1 litre the car will go km.
25
150
Hence, with 30 litres of petrol it would go × 30 km = 180 km
25
In this method, we first found the value for one unit or the unit rate. This is done by the
comparison of two different properties. For example, when you compare total cost to
number of items, we get cost per item or if you take distance travelled to time taken, we get
distance per unit time.
Thus, you can see that we often use per to mean for each.
For example, km per hour, children per teacher etc., denote unit rates.
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 157
EXERCISE 8.1
1. Find the ratio of:
(a) ` 5 to 50 paise (b) 15 kg to 210 g
(c) 9 m to 27 cm (d) 30 days to 36 hours
2. In a computer lab, there are 3 computers for every 6 students. How many
computers will be needed for 24 students?
d
3. Population of Rajasthan = 570 lakhs and population of UP = 1660 lakhs.
he
Area of Rajasthan = 3 lakh km2 and area of UP = 2 lakh km2.
pu T
(i) How many people are there per km2 in both these States?
is
re ER
(ii) Which State is less populated? bl
8.3 PERCENTAGE – ANOTHER WAY OF COMPARING QUANTITIES
be NC
you agree with her? Who do you think has done better?
tt
Mansi told them that they cannot decide who has done better by just comparing the
no
total marks obtained because the maximum marks out of which they got the marks are not
the same.
She said why don’t you see the Percentages given in your report cards?
Anita’s Percentage was 80 and Rita’s was 83.3. So, this shows Rita has done better.
Do you agree?
Percentages are numerators of fractions with denominator 100 and have been
used in comparing results. Let us try to understand in detail about it.
2020-21
158 MATHEMATICS
d
Total 100
he
TRY THESE
pu T
is
re ER
bl
1. Find the Percentage of children of different heights for the following data.
be NC
128 cm 32
130 cm 21
o
Total 100
tt
no
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 159
Anwar found the Percentage of red beads like this Asha does it like this
Out of 20 beads, the number of red beads is 8. 8 8× 5
=
Hence, out of 100, the number of red beads is 20 20 × 5
d
8 40
he
× 100 = 40 (out of hundred) = 40% == = 40%
20 pu T 100
is
re ER
We see that these three methods can be used to find the Percentage when the total
bl
does not add to give 100. In the method shown in the table, we multiply the fraction by
be NC
100
. This does not change the value of the fraction. Subsequently, only 100 remains in the
100
denominator.
5
©
Anwar has used the unitary method. Asha has multiplied by to get 100 in the
5
denominator. You can use whichever method you find suitable. May be, you can make
your own method too.
o
The method used by Anwar can work for all ratios. Can the method used by Asha also
tt
work for all ratios? Anwar says Asha’s method can be used only if you can find a natural
number which on multiplication with the denominator gives 100. Since denominator was 20,
no
she could multiply it by 5 to get 100. If the denominator was 6, she would not have been
able to use this method. Do you agree?
TRY THESE
1. A collection of 10 chips with different colours is given .
Colour Number Fraction Denominator Hundred In Percentage
Green G G G G
Blue B B B
Red R
R R
Total
Fill the table and find the percentage of chips of each colour.
2020-21
160 MATHEMATICS
2. Mala has a collection of bangles. She has 20 gold bangles and 10 silver bangles.
What is the percentage of bangles of each type? Can you put it in the tabular form
as done in the above example?
d
he
2. A shirt has:
pu T
3
is
re ER
Cotton 60% Cotton
5bl
2 or
be NC
our denominator is 100. That is, we are converting the fractions to Percentages. Let us try
tt
From these examples, we find that the percentages related to proper fractions are less
than 100 whereas percentages related to improper fractions are more than 100.
d
he
EXAMPLE 10 Convert the given decimals to per cents:
pu T
(a) 0.75 (b) 0.09 (c) 0.2
is
re ER
SOLUTION
bl
be NC
9
(a) 0.75 = 0.75 × 100 % (b) 0.09 = =9%
100
75
= × 100 % = 75%
100
©
2
(c) 0.2 = × 100% = 20 %
10
o
TRY THESE
tt
no
2020-21
162 MATHEMATICS
d
the whole when added together gives the whole or 100%.
he
So, if we are given one part, we can always find out the
pu T
other part. Suppose, 30% of a given number of students are boys.
is
re ER
This means that if there were 100 students, 30 out of them would be boys and the
bl
remaining would be girls.
be NC
TRY THESE
1. 35% + _______% = 100%, 64% + 20% +________ % = 100%
o
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 163
TRY THESE
What per cent of these figures are shaded?
(i) (ii)
d
1 1
he
4
pu T 16
1 1
is
re ER
8 1 4
bl 16
1 1
be NC
8 8
Tangram
You can make some more figures yourself and ask your friends to estimate the
shaded parts.
©
We saw how percentages were helpful in comparison. We have also learnt to convert
fractional numbers and decimals to percentages. Now, we shall learn how percentages
no
can be used in real life. For this, we start with interpreting the following statements:
— 5 % of the income is saved by Ravi. — 20% of Meera’s dresses are blue in colour.
— Rekha gets 10 % on every book sold by her.
What can you infer from each of these statements?
5
By 5 % we mean 5 parts out of 100 or we write it as . It means Ravi is saving
100
` 5 out of every ` 100 that he earns. In the same way, interpret the rest of the statements
given above.
8.4.2 Converting Percentages to “How Many”
Consider the following examples:
EXAMPLE 12 A survey of 40 children showed that 25% liked playing football. How
many children liked playing football?
SOLUTION Here, the total number of children are 40. Out of these, 25% like playing
football. Meena and Arun used the following methods to find the number.
You can choose either method.
2020-21
164 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
1. Find:
1
(a) 50% of 164 (b) 75% of 12 (c) 12 % of 64
2
d
2. 8 % children of a class of 25 like getting wet in the rain. How many children like
he
getting wet in the rain.
pu T
EXAMPLE 13 Rahul bought a sweater and saved ` 200 when a discount of 25% was
is
re ER
given. What was the price of the sweater before the discount?
bl
be NC
SOLUTION Rahul has saved ` 200 when price of sweater is reduced by 25%. This
means that 25% reduction in price is the amount saved by Rahul. Let us
see how Mohan and Abdul have found the original cost of the sweater.
©
25 100
So, 25% of P = 200 or × P = 200 = × 200 = ` 800
no
100 25
P Thus both obtained the original price of
or, = 200 or P = 200 × 4
4 sweater as ` 800.
Therefore, P = 800
TRY THESE
1. 9 is 25% of what number? 2. 75% of what number is 15?
EXERCISE 8.2
1. Convert the given fractional numbers to per cents.
1 5 3 2
(a) (b) (c) (d)
8 4 40 7
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 165
d
(a) 5% of it is 600. (b) 12% of it is ` 1080. (c) 40% of it is 500 km.
he
(d) 70% of it is 14 minutes.
pu T (e) 8% of it is 40 litres.
is
re ER
6. Convert given per cents to decimal fractions and also to fractions in simplest forms:
bl
(a) 25% (b) 150% (c) 20% (d) 5%
be NC
7. In a city, 30% are females, 40% are males and remaining are children. What per cent
are children?
8. Out of 15,000 voters in a constituency, 60% voted. Find the percentage of voters
©
who did not vote. Can you now find how many actually did not vote?
9. Meeta saves ` 4000 from her salary. If this is 10% of her salary. What is her salary?
o
10. A local cricket team played 20 matches in one season. It won 25% of them. How
many matches did they win?
tt
Sometimes, parts are given to us in the form of ratios and we need to convert those to
percentages. Consider the following example:
EXAMPLE 14 Reena’s mother said, to make idlis, you must take two parts rice and
one part urad dal. What percentage of such a mixture would be rice
and what percentage would be urad dal?
SOLUTION In terms of ratio we would write this as Rice : Urad dal = 2 : 1.
rd rd
2 1
Now, 2 + 1=3 is the total of all parts. This means part is rice and part is urad dal.
3 3
2 200 2
Then, percentage of rice would be × 100 % = = 66 % .
3 3 3
1 100 1
Percentage of urad dal would be × 100 % = = 33 % .
3 3 3
2020-21
166 MATHEMATICS
EXAMPLE 15 If ` 250 is to be divided amongst Ravi, Raju and Roy, so that Ravi gets
two parts, Raju three parts and Roy five parts. How much money will
each get? What will it be in percentages?
SOLUTION The parts which the three boys are getting can be written in terms of
ratios as 2 : 3 : 5. Total of the parts is 2 + 3 + 5 = 10.
Amounts received by each Percentages of money for each
2 2
× ` 250 = ` 50 Ravi gets ×100 % = 20 %
10 10
3 3
× ` 250 = ` 75 Raju gets ×100 % = 30 %
10 10
5 5
× ` 250 = ` 125 Roy gets ×100 % = 50 %
d
10 10
he
TRY THESE pu T
is
re ER
1. Divide 15 sweets between Manu and Sonu so that they get 20 %
bl
and 80 % of them respectively.
be NC
There are times when we need to know the increase or decrease in a certain quantity as
percentage. For example, if the population of a state increased from 5,50,000 to
o
6,05,000. Then the increase in population can be understood better if we say, the
tt
population increased by 10 %.
How do we convert the increase or decrease in a quantity as a percentage of the initial
no
EXAMPLE 16 A school team won 6 games this year against 4 games won last year.
What is the per cent increase?
SOLUTION The increase in the number of wins (or amount of change) = 6 – 4 = 2.
amount of change
Percentage increase = × 100
original amount or base
increase in the number of wins 2
= ×100 = × 100 = 50
original number of wins 4
EXAMPLE 17 The number of illiterate persons in a country decreased from 150 lakhs
to 100 lakhs in 10 years. What is the percentage of decrease?
SOLUTION Original amount = the number of illiterate persons initially = 150 lakhs.
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 167
Amount of change = decrease in the number of illiterate persons = 150 – 100 = 50 lakhs
Therefore, the percentage of decrease
amount of change 50 1
= × 100 = × 100 = 33
original amount 150 3
TRY THESE
1. Find Percentage of increase or decrease:
– Price of shirt decreased from ` 280 to ` 210.
– Marks in a test increased from 20 to 30.
2. My mother says, in her childhood petrol was ` 1 a litre. It is ` 52 per litre today. By
what Percentage has the price gone up?
d
8.5 PRICES RELATED TO AN ITEM OR BUYING AND SELLING
he
I bought it for ` 600 pu T
is
re ER
bl and will sell it for ` 610
be NC
The buying price of any item is known as its cost price. It is written in short as CP.
The price at which you sell is known as the selling price or in short SP.
What would you say is better, to you sell the item at a lower price, same price or higher
©
price than your buying price? You can decide whether the sale was profitable or not
depending on the CP and SP. If CP < SP then you made a profit = SP – CP.
If CP = SP then you are in a no profit no loss situation.
o
2020-21
168 MATHEMATICS
d
Therefore, Loss = ` 120 – ` 100 = ` 20
he
Loss per cent =
Loss pu T
×100 On ` 120, the loss is ` 20
is
re ER
CP So on ` 100, the loss
20
×100
bl 20 50 2
= = × 100 = = 16
be NC
120 120 3 3
50 2 2
= = 16 Thus, loss per cent is 16
3 3 3
©
EXAMPLE 18 The cost of a flower vase is ` 120. If the shopkeeper sells it at a loss
tt
SOLUTION We are given that CP = ` 120 and Loss per cent = 10. We have to find
the SP.
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 169
EXAMPLE 19 Selling price of a toy car is ` 540. If the profit made by shopkeeper is
20%, what is the cost price of this toy?
SOLUTION We are given that SP = ` 540 and the Profit = 20%. We need to find the CP.
Amina does it like this Arun does it like this
20% profit will mean if CP is ` 100, Profit = 20% of CP and SP = CP + Profit
profit is ` 20 So, 540 = CP + 20% of CP
Therefore, SP = 100 + 20 = 120 20 1
Now, when SP is ` 120, = CP + × CP = 1 + 5 CP
100
then CP is ` 100.
6
Therefore, when SP is ` 540, = CP . Therefore, 540 × 5 = CP
100 5 6
then CP = × 540 = ` 450 or ` 450 = CP
120
d
he
Thus, by both methods, the cost price is ` 450.
pu T
is
re ER
TRY THESE bl
1. A shopkeeper bought a chair for ` 375 and sold it for ` 400. Find the gain Percentage.
be NC
2. Cost of an item is ` 50. It was sold with a profit of 12%. Find the selling price.
3. An article was sold for ` 250 with a profit of 5%. What was its cost price?
4. An item was sold for ` 540 at a loss of 5%. What was its cost price?
©
Sohini said that they were going to buy a new scooter. Mohan asked her
whether they had the money to buy it. Sohini said her father was going
no
to take a loan from a bank. The money you borrow is known as sum
borrowed or principal.
This money would be used by the borrower for some time before it is
returned. For keeping this money for some time the borrower has to pay
some extra money to the bank. This is known as Interest.
You can find the amount you have to pay at the end of the year by adding the sum
borrowed and the interest. That is, Amount = Principal + Interest.
Interest is generally given in per cent for a period of one year. It is written as say 10%
per year or per annum or in short as 10% p.a. (per annum).
10% p.a. means on every ` 100 borrowed, ` 10 is the interest you have to pay for one
year. Let us take an example and see how this works.
EXAMPLE 20 Anita takes a loan of ` 5,000 at 15% per year as rate of interest. Find
the interest she has to pay at the end of one year.
2020-21
170 MATHEMATICS
SOLUTION The sum borrowed = ` 5,000, Rate of interest = 15% per year.
This means if ` 100 is borrowed, she has to pay ` 15 as interest for one year. If she has
borrowed ` 5,000, then the interest she has to pay for one year
15
=` × 5000 = ` 750
100
So, at the end of the year she has to give an amount of ` 5,000 + ` 750 = ` 5,750.
We can write a general relation to find interest for one year. Take P as the principal or
sum and R % as Rate per cent per annum.
Now on every ` 100 borrowed, the interest paid is ` R
R× P P× R
Therefore, on ` P borrowed, the interest paid for one year would be = .
100 100
8.6.1 Interest for Multiple Years
d
If the amount is borrowed for more than one year the interest is calculated for the period
he
the money is kept for. For example, if Anita returns the money at the end of two years and
pu T
the rate of interest is the same then she would have to pay twice the interest i.e., ` 750 for
is
re ER
the first year and ` 750 for the second. This way of calculating interest where principal is
bl
not changed is known as simple interest. As the number of years increase the interest
also increases. For ` 100 borrowed for 3 years at 18%, the interest to be paid at the end
be NC
of 3 years is 18 + 18 + 18 = 3 × 18 = ` 54.
We can find the general form for simple interest for more than one year.
We know that on a principal of ` P at R% rate of interest per year, the interest paid for
©
R×P
one year is . Therefore, interest I paid for T years would be
100
o
T × R × P P × R ×T PRT
= or
tt
TRY THESE
1. ` 10,000 is invested at 5% interest rate p.a. Find the interest at the end of one
year.
2. ` 3,500 is given at 7% p.a. rate of interest. Find the interest which will be received
at the end of two years.
3. ` 6,050 is borrowed at 6.5% rate of interest p.a.. Find the interest and the amount
to be paid at the end of 3 years.
4. ` 7,000 is borrowed at 3.5% rate of interest p.a. borrowed for 2 years. Find the
amount to be paid at the end of the second year.
Just as in the case of prices related to items, if you are given any two of the three
P ×T × R
quantities in the relation I = , you could find the remaining quantity.
100
2020-21
COMPARING QUANTITIES 171
Solution 1 Solution 2
P ×T × R For 2 years, interest paid is ` 750
I=
100 Therefore, for 1 year, interest paid ` = ` 375
4500 × 2 × R
Therefore, 750 = On ` 4,500, interest paid is ` 375
100
750 Therefore, on ` 100, rate of interest paid
or =R
45 × 2 375 × 100 1
1 = =8 %
Therefore, Rate = 8 % 4500 3
3
TRY THESE
d
he
1. You have ` 2,400 in your account and the interest rate is 5%. After how many years
pu T
would you earn ` 240 as interest.
is
re ER
2. On a certain sum the interest paid after 3 years is ` 450 at 5% rate of interest per
bl
annum. Find the sum.
be NC
EXERCISE 8.3
1. Tell what is the profit or loss in the following transactions. Also find profit per cent or
©
2020-21
172 MATHEMATICS
8. Amina buys a book for ` 275 and sells it at a loss of 15%. How much does she sell
it for?
9. Find the amount to be paid at the end of 3 years in each case:
(a) Principal = ` 1,200 at 12% p.a. (b) Principal = ` 7,500 at 5% p.a.
10. What rate gives ` 280 as interest on a sum of ` 56,000 in 2 years?
11. If Meena gives an interest of ` 45 for one year at 9% rate p.a.. What is the sum she
has borrowed?
d
as the ratio 150 : 75 or 2 : 1.
he
3. Two ratios can be compared by converting them to like fractions. If the two fractions
pu T
are equal, we say the two given ratios are equivalent.
is
re ER
4. If two ratios are equivalent then the four quantities are said to be in proportion. For
bl
example, the ratios 8 : 2 and 16 : 4 are equivalent therefore 8, 2, 16 and 4 are in
be NC
proportion.
5. A way of comparing quantities is percentage. Percentages are numerators of fractions
with denominator 100. Per cent means per hundred.
For example 82% marks means 82 marks out of hundred.
©
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 173
Chapter 9
Rational
Numbers
d
9.1 INTRODUCTION
he
You began your study of numbers by counting objects around you.
is
The numbers used for this purpose were called counting numbers or
natural numbers. They are 1, 2, 3, 4, ... By including 0 to natural
bl
numbers, we got the whole numbers, i.e., 0, 1, 2, 3, ... The negatives
pu
of natural numbers were then put together with whole numbers to make
be T
up integers. Integers are ..., –3, –2, –1, 0, 1, 2, 3, .... We, thus, extended
o R
the number system, from natural numbers to whole numbers and from
re
numerator
You were also introduced to fractions. These are numbers of the form ,
denominator
no N
where the numerator is either 0 or a positive integer and the denominator, a positive integer.
You compared two fractions, found their equivalent forms and studied all the four basic
operations of addition, subtraction, multiplication and division on them.
©
In this Chapter, we shall extend the number system further. We shall introduce the concept
of rational numbers alongwith their addition, subtraction, multiplication and division operations.
2020-21
174 MATHEMATICS
d
4
he
3 4 2
l You have seen many fractions like , ,1 etc. All fractions are rational
8 8 3
numbers. Can you say why?
is
How about the decimal numbers like 0.5, 2.3, etc.? Each of such numbers can be
bl 5
written as an ordinary fraction and, hence, are rational numbers. For example, 0.5 = ,
pu
10
be T
333
o R
0.333 = etc.
re
1000
t t CE
TRY THESE
2
no N
1. Is the number rational? Think about it. 2. List ten rational numbers.
−3
©
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 175
–2 ( –2) × ( –5) 10 –2 10
Also, = = . So, is also the same as .
3 3 × ( –5) –15 3 −15
– 2 −4 10
Thus, = = . Such rational numbers that are equal to each other are said to
3 6 −15
d
be equivalent to each other.
he
10 −10
Again, = (How?)
−15
is
15
bl
By multiplying the numerator and denominator of a rational
number by the same non zero integer, we obtain another rational
pu
TRY THESE
be T
–15 24 2 (ii)
7 14
–2 2 –10 10
We write as – , as – , etc.
3 3 15 15
–3
TRY THESE
The numerator of is a negative integer, whereas the denominator 1. Is 5 a positive rational
5
number?
is a positive integer. Such a rational number is called a negative rational
2. List five more positive
−5 −3 −9 rational numbers.
number. So, , , etc. are negative rational numbers.
7 8 5
2020-21
176 MATHEMATICS
8 8 8× − 1 −8
l Is a negative rational number? We know that = = ,
TRY THESE −3 −3 − 3× − 1 3
1. Is – 8 a negative −8 8
and is a negative rational number. So, is a negative rational number.
rational number? 3 −3
2. List five more 5 6 2
negative rational Similarly, , , etc. are all negative rational numbers. Note that
−7 −5 −9
numbers.
their numerators are positive and their denominators negative.
l The number 0 is neither a positive nor a negative rational number.
−3
l What about ?
−5
−3 −3 × ( −1) 3 −3
You will see that = = . So, is a positive rational number.
−5 −5 × ( −1) 5 −5
d
−2 −5
he
Thus, , etc. are positive rational numbers.
−5 −3
TRY THESE
is
bl
Which of these are negative rational numbers?
pu
be T
−2 5 3 6 −2
o R
3 7 −5 11 −9
t t CE
You know how to represent integers on a number line. Let us draw one such number line.
©
The points to the right of 0 are denoted by + sign and are positive integers. The points
to the left of 0 are denoted by – sign and are negative integers.
Representation of fractions on a number line is also known to you.
Let us see how the rational numbers can be represented on a number line.
1
Let us represent the number − on the number line.
2
As done in the case of positive integers, the positive rational numbers would be marked
on the right of 0 and the negative rational numbers would be marked on the left of 0.
1
To which side of 0 will you mark − ? Being a negative rational number, it would be
2
marked to the left of 0.
You know that while marking integers on the number line, successive integers are
marked at equal intervels. Also, from 0, the pair 1 and –1 is equidistant. So are the pairs 2
and – 2, 3 and –3.
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 177
1 1
In the same way, the rational numbersand − would be at equal distance from 0.
2 2
1
We know how to mark the rational number . It is marked at a point which is half the
2
1
distance between 0 and 1. So, − would be marked at a point half the distance between
2
0 and –1.
3
We know how to mark on the number line. It is marked on the right of 0 and lies
2
−3
halfway between 1 and 2. Let us now mark on the number line. It lies on the left of 0
d
2
he
3
and is at the same distance as from 0.
2
is
−1 − 2 −3 −4
In decreasing order, we have, bl , (= −1) , , (= − 2) . This shows that
2 2 2 2
−3 −3
pu
lies between – 1 and – 2. Thus, lies halfway between – 1 and – 2.
be T
2 2
o R
re
t t CE
−4 −3 −2 −1 0 1 2 3 4
= ( −2) = ( −1) = (0) = (1) = ( 2)
2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
no N
−5 −7
Mark and in a similar way.
2 2
©
1 1
Similarly, − is to the left of zero and at the same distance from zero as is to the
3 3
1
right. So as done above, − can be represented on the number line. Once we know how
3
1 2 4 5
to represent − on the number line, we can go on representing − , − , − and so on.
3 3 3 3
All other rational numbers with different denominators can be represented in a similar way.
2020-21
178 MATHEMATICS
d
We had to divide twice. First time by 3 and then by 5. This could also be done as
he
−45 −45 ÷ 15 −3
= =
is
30 30 ÷ 15 2
bl
In this example, note that 15 is the HCF of 45 and 30.
Thus, to reduce the rational number to its standard form, we divide its numerator
pu
be T
and denominator by their HCF ignoring the negative sign, if any. (The reason for
o R
36 −3
(i) (ii)
−24 −15
©
SOLUTION
(i) The HCF of 36 and 24 is 12.
Thus, its standard form would be obtained by dividing by –12.
36 36 ÷ ( −12) −3
= =
−24 −24 ÷ ( −12) 2
(ii) The HCF of 3 and 15 is 3.
−3 −3 ÷ ( −2) 1
Thus, = =
−15 −15 ÷ ( −3) 5
TRY THESE
−18 −12
Find the standard form of (i) (ii)
45 18
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 179
d
the right of – 5 on the number line and – 2 > – 5.
he
She used this method for rational numbers also. She knew how to mark rational numbers
1 1
is
on the number line. She marked − and − as follows:
2 bl 5
pu
be T
–1 0 1
o R
re
−1 −5 −1 −2
= =
t t CE
2 10 5 10
1 5
Has she correctly marked the two points? How and why did she convert −
to −
no N
2 10
1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
and − to − ? She found that − is to the right of − . Thus, − > − or − < − .
©
5 10 5 2 5 2 2 5
3 2 1 1
Can you compare − and − ? − and − ?
4 3 3 5
1 1 1
We know from our study of fractions that < . And what did Mary get for −
5 2 2
1
and − ? Was it not exactly the opposite?
5
1 1 1 1
You will find that, > but − < − .
2 5 2 5
3 2 1 1
Do you observe the same for − , − and − , − ?
4 3 3 5
Mary remembered that in integers she had studied 4 > 3
but – 4 < –3, 5 > 2 but –5 < –2 etc.
2020-21
180 MATHEMATICS
l The case of pairs of negative rational numbers is similar. To compare two negative
rational numbers, we compare them ignoring their negative signs and then reverse
the order.
7 5 7 5
For example, to compare − and − , we first compare and .
5 3 5 3
7 5 –7 –5
We get < and conclude that > .
5 3 5 3
3 2 4 3
Which is greater − or − ?; − or − ?
d
8 7 3 2
he
l Comparison of a negative and a positive rational number is obvious. A negative rational
is
number is to the left of zero whereas a positive rational number is to the right of zero on
bl
a number line. So, a negative rational number will always be less than a positive rational
number.
pu
be T
2 1
o R
Thus, − < .
re
7 2
t t CE
−3 −2
l To compare rational numbers and reduce them to their standard forms and
no N
−5 −7
then compare them.
©
4 −16
EXAMPLE 3 Do and represent the same rational number?
−9 36
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 181
Thus, we find that number of integers between two integers are limited (finite).
Will the same happen in the case of rational numbers also?
−3 −1
Reshma took two rational numbers and .
5 3
She converted them to rational numbers with same denominators.
−3 −9 −1 −5
So = and =
5 15 3 15
−9 −8 −7 −6 −5 −3 −8 −7 −6 −1
We have < < < < or < < < <
15 15 15 15 15 5 15 15 15 3
−8 −7 −6 −3 −1
She could find rational numbers < < between and .
d
15 15 15 5 3
he
−8 −7 −6 3 1
Are the numbers , , the only rational numbers between − and − ?
15 15 15 5 3
−3 −18 −8 −16
is
< <
bl
We have and
5 30 15 30
pu
be T
And . i.e.,
30 30 30 5 30 15
t t CE
−3 −17 −8 −7 −6 −1
Hence < < < < <
no N
5 30 15 15 15 3
−3 −1
So, we could find one more rational number between and .
©
5 3
By using this method, you can insert as many rational numbers as you want between
two different rational numbers.
−3 −3 × 30 −90 −1 −1 × 50 −50
For example, = = and = =
5 5 × 30 150 3 3 × 50 150
−89 −51 −90 −50
We get 39 rational numbers , ..., between and i.e., between
150 150 150 150
−3 −1
and . You will find that the list is unending.
5 3
TRY THESE
−5 −8
Can you list five rational numbers between and ? Find five rational numbers
3 7
We can find unlimited number of rational numbers between any two −5 −3
between and .
rational numbers. 7 8
2020-21
182 MATHEMATICS
−10 −9 −8 −7 −6 −5 −9 −8 −7 −6
So, < < < < < or −2 < < < < < −1
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
−9 −8 −7
The three rational numbers between –2 and –1 would be, , ,
5 5 5
−9 −8 −7 −6
, , , )
d
(You can take any three of
5 5 5 5
he
EXAMPLE 5 Write four more numbers in the following pattern:
is
−1 −2 −3 −4
bl
, , , ,...
3 6 9 12
pu
be T
SOLUTION We have,
o R
re
t t CE
−2 −1 × 2 − 3 −1 × 3 − 4 −1 × 4
= , = , =
6 3× 2 9 3 × 3 12 3× 4
no N
−1 × 1 −1 −1 × 2 −2 −1 × 3 −3 −1 × 4 −4
or = , = , = , =
3 ×1 3 3×2 6 3×3 9 3 × 4 12
©
EXERCISE 9.1
1. List five rational numbers between:
−4 −2 1 2
(i) –1 and 0 (ii) –2 and –1 (iii) and (iv) – and
5 3 2 3
2. Write four more rational numbers in each of the following patterns:
−3 −6 −9 −12 −1 −2 −3
(i) , , , ,..... (ii) , , ,.....
5 10 15 20 4 8 12
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 183
−1 2 3 4 −2 2 4 6
(iii) , , , ,..... (iv) , , , ,.....
6 −12 −18 −24 3 −3 −6 −9
3. Give four rational numbers equivalent to:
−2 5 4
(i) (ii) (iii)
7 −3 9
4. Draw the number line and represent the following rational numbers on it:
3 −5 −7 7
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
4 8 4 8
d
and AP = PQ = QB. Name the rational numbers represented by P, Q, R and S.
he
is
bl
pu
6. Which of the following pairs represent the same rational number?
be T
o R
−7 3 −16 20 −2 2
re
21 9 20 3
−3 −12 8 −24 1 −1
no N
−5 5
(vii) and
−9 −9
7. Rewrite the following rational numbers in the simplest form:
−8 25 − 44 −8
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
6 45 72 10
8. Fill in the boxes with the correct symbol out of >, <, and =.
−5 2 −4 −5 −7 14
(i) (ii) (iii)
7 3 5 7 8 −16
−8 −7 1 −1 5 −5
(iv) (v) (vi)
5 4 −3 4 −11 11
−7
(vii) 0
6
2020-21
184 MATHEMATICS
−1 1 2 4
(iv) , (v) −3 , −3
4 4 7 5
10. Write the following rational numbers in ascending order:
−3 −2 −1 −1 −2 −4 −3 −3 −3
(i) , , (ii) , , (iii) , ,
5 5 5 3 9 3 7 2 4
d
You know how to add, subtract, multiply and divide integers as well as fractions. Let us
he
now study these basic operations on rational numbers.
is
9.9.1 Addition bl 7 −5
l Let us add two rational numbers with same denominators, say and .
pu
3 3
be T
7 −5
o R
re
We find +
3 3
t t CE
−3 −2 −1 0 1 2 3 54 6 7 8
©
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 33 3 3 3
1 −5 7
The distance between two consecutive points is . So adding to will
3 3 3
7 2
mean, moving to the left of , making 5 jumps. Where do we reach? We reach at .
3 3
7 −5 2
So, + = .
3 3 3
Let us now try this way:
7 (−5) 7 + (−5) 2
+ = =
3 3 3 3
We get the same answer.
6 (−2) 3 (−5)
Find + , + in both ways and check if you get the same answers.
5 5 7 7
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 185
−7 5
Similarly, + would be
8 8
−7 −6 −5 −4 −3 −2 −1 0 1 2 3 4 5
8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8
What do you get?
−7 5 −7 + 5
Also, + = = ? Are the two values same?
8 8 8
TRY THESE
−13 6 19 + −7
d
Find: + , 5 5
7 7
he
So, we find that while adding rational numbers with same denominators, we add
is
the numerators keeping the denominators same.
bl
−11 7 −11 + 7 − 4
+ = =
pu
Thus,
be T
5 5 5 5
o R
re
fractions, we first find the LCM of the two denominators. Then, we find the equivalent
rational numbers of the given rational numbers with this LCM as the denominator.
no N
5 3
LCM of 5 and 3 is 15.
−7 −21 −2 −10
So, = and =
5 15 3 15
−4 4 −4+ 4 4 − 4 2 −5 −3
+ = = 0 . Also, + = 0 . (ii) ,+
7 7 7 7 7 3 6 11
2020-21
186 MATHEMATICS
−2 2 2 −2
Similarly, + = 0 = + .
3 3 3 3
In the case of integers, we call – 2 as the additive inverse
of 2 and 2 as the additive inverse of – 2.
−4
For rational numbers also, we call as the additive
7
4 4 −4
inverse of and as the additive inverse of . Similarly,
7 7 7
−2 2 2 −2
is the additive inverse of and is the additive inverse of .
3 3 3 3
d
TRY THESE
he
−3 −9 5
What will be the additive inverse of ?, ?, ?
is
9 11 7
bl 2
EXAMPLE 6 Satpal walks km from a place P, towards east and then from there
pu
3
be T
5
o R
1
re
SOLUTION Let us denote the distance travelled towards east by positive sign. So,
the distances towards west would be denoted by negative sign.
no N
+ −1 = + = +
3 7 3 7 3× 7 7×3
14 − 36 −22 1
= = = −1
21 21 21
<
P
1
Since it is negative, it means Satpal is at a distance 1 km towards west of P.
21
9.9.2 Subtraction
5 3
Savita found the difference of two rational numbers and in this way:
7 8
5 3 40 − 21 19
− = =
7 8 56 56
Farida knew that for two integers a and b she could write a – b = a + (– b)
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 187
5 3 5 ( −3) 19
She tried this for rational numbers also and found, − = + = .
7 8 7 8 56
Both obtained the same difference.
7 5 3 8
Try to find − , − in both ways. Did you get the same answer?
8 9 11 7
So, we say while subtracting two rational numbers, we add the additive inverse of
the rational number that is being subtracted, to the other rational number.
2 4 5 14 5 14 5 ( −14)
Thus, 1 −2 = − = + additive inverse of = +
3 5 3 5 3 5 3 5
d
= = −1 .
15 15
he
Find:
2 −5 7 2 1 ( −1)
− (ii) 2 −
is
What will be − ? (i)
9 5 5 3
7 6 bl
2 −5 2 −5 2 5 47
pu
5
be T
− = + additive inverse of = + = =1
7 6 7 6 7 6 42 42
o R
re
t t CE
9.9.3 Multiplication
−3 −3
no N
3
On the number line, it will mean two jumps of to the left.
5
−6 −5 −4 −3 −2 −1 0 1 2 3
( = 0)
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
−6
Where do we reach? We reach at . Let us find it as we did in fractions.
5
−3 −3 × 2 −6
×2= =
5 5 5
We arrive at the same rational number.
−4 −6
Find × 3, × 4 using both ways. What do you observe?
7 5
2020-21
188 MATHEMATICS
−5
Remember, –5 can be written as= .
TRY THESE 1
What will be
−2 −5 10 −2 × ( −5)
−3 −6 So, × = =
(i) × 7? (ii) × ( −2) ? 9 1 9 9 ×1
5 5
3 × ( −2) − 6
d
3
Similarly, × ( −2) = =
he
11 11×1 11
is
−3 5 −3 × 5 −15
Based on these observations, we find that, × = =
8 7 8×7
bl 56
pu
So, as we did in the case of fractions, we multiply two rational numbers in the
be T
following way:
o R
re
TRY THESE Step 2 Multiply the denominators of the two rational numbers.
Find:
no N
Result of Step 1
−3 1 Step 3 Write the product as
(i) × Result of Step 2
4 7
©
2 −5 −3 2 −3 × 2 −6
(ii) × Thus, × = = .
3 9 5 7 5×7 35
−5 −9 −5 × ( −9) 45
Also, × = =
8 7 8× 7 56
9.9.4 Division
2
We have studied reciprocals of a fraction earlier. What is the reciprocal of ? It will be
7
7
. We extend this idea of reciprocals to non-zero rational numbers also.
2
−2 7 −7 −3 −5
The reciprocal of will be i.e., ; that of would be .
7 −2 2 5 3
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 189
TRY THESE
−6 −8
What will be the reciprocal of ? and ?
11 5
Product of reciprocals
The product of a rational number with its reciprocal is always 1.
−4 −4
For example, × reciprocal of
9 9
−4 −9
= × =1
d
9 4
he
−6 −13
Similarly, × =1
is
13bl 6
Try some more examples and confirm this observation.
pu
be T
4 −5
o R
9 7
t t CE
4 −5 4 7 −28
÷ = × = .
9 7 9 −5 45
no N
4 5 28
Arpit first divided by and got .
9 7 45
4 −5 −28
He finally said ÷ = . How did he get that?
9 7 45
He divided them as fractions, ignoring the negative sign and then put the negative sign
in the value so obtained.
−28 2 −5
Both of them got the same value . Try dividing by both ways and see if
45 3 7
you get the same answer.
This shows, to divide one rational number by the other non-zero rational number
we multiply the rational number by the reciprocal of the other.
Thus,
2020-21
190 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
2 −7 –6 5
Find: (i) × (ii) ×
3 8 7 7
EXERCISE 9.2
1. Find the sum:
5 −11 5 3 −9 22
(i) + (ii) + (iii) +
4 4 3 5 10 15
−3 5 −8 (−2) −2
d
(iv) + (v) + (vi) +0
−11 9
he
19 57 3
1 3
is
(vii) −2 + 4
3 5 bl
2. Find
pu
be T
7 17 5 −6 −6 −7
o R
− − −
re
−3 7 1
(iv) − (v) −2 − 6
no N
8 11 9
3. Find the product:
©
9 −7 3 −6 9
(i) × (ii) × ( −9 ) (iii) ×
2 4 10 5 11
3 −2 3 2 3 −5
(iv) × (v) × (vi) ×
7 5 11 5 −5 3
4. Find the value of:
2 −3 −4
(i) ( − 4) ÷ (ii) ÷2 (iii) ÷ ( −3)
3 5 5
−1 3 −2 1 − 7 −2
(iv) ÷ (v) ÷ (vi) ÷
8 4 13 7 12 13
3 −4
(vii) ÷
13 65
2020-21
RATIONAL NUMBERS 191
−2 3
q ≠ 0, is called a rational number. The numbers , ,3 etc. are rational numbers.
7 8
2. All integers and fractions are rational numbers.
3. If the numerator and denominator of a rational number are multiplied or divided by a
non-zero integer, we get a rational number which is said to be equivalent to the given
−3 −3 × 2 − 6 −6
rational number. For example = = . So, we say is the equivalent
7 7 × 2 14 14
d
−3 −6 − 6 ÷ 2 − 3
= =
he
form of . Also note that .
7 14 14 ÷ 2 7
is
4. Rational numbers are classified as Positive and Negative rational numbers. When the
numerator and denominator, both, are positive integers, it is a positive rational number.
bl
When either the numerator or the denominator is a negative integer, it is a negative
pu
be T
3 −8
rational number. For example, is a positive rational number whereas is a
o R
re
8 9
t t CE
−1 2
The numbers , etc. are in standard form.
3 7
7. There are unlimited number of rational numbers between two rational numbers.
8. Two rational numbers with the same denominator can be added by adding their
numerators, keeping the denominator same. Two rational numbers with different
denominators are added by first taking the LCM of the two denominators and
then converting both the rational numbers to their equivalent forms having the
−2 3 −16 9 −16 + 9 −7
LCM as the denominator. For example, + = + = = . Here,
3 8 24 24 24 24
LCM of 3 and 8 is 24.
9. While subtracting two rational numbers, we add the additive inverse of the rational
number to be subtracted to the other rational number.
7 2 7 2 7 ( −2) 21+ ( −16) 5
Thus, − = + additive inverse of = + = = .
8 3 8 3 8 3 24 24
2020-21
192 MATHEMATICS
10. To multiply two rational numbers, we multiply their numerators and denominators
product of numerators .
separately, and write the product as
product of denominators
11. To divide one rational number by the other non-zero rational number, we multiply the
rational number by the reciprocal of the other. Thus,
−7 4 −7 4 −7 3 − 21
÷ = × (reciprocal of ) = × = .
2 3 2 3 2 4 8
d
he
is
bl
pu
be T
o R
re
t t CE
no N
©
2020-21
PRACTICAL GEOMETRY 193
Chapter 10
Practical
Geometry
d
10.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
You are familiar with a number of shapes. You learnt how to draw some of them in the earlier
is
re ER
classes. For example, you can draw a line segment of given length, a line perpendicular to a
bl
given line segment, an angle, an angle bisector, a circle etc.
be NC
Now, you will learn how to draw parallel lines and some types of triangles.
2020-21
194 MATHEMATICS
You can use any one of the properties regarding the transversal and parallel lines to
make this construction using ruler and compasses only.
Step 1 Take a line ‘l ’ and a point ‘A’ outside ‘l ’ [Fig10.2 (i)].
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
Step 3 With B as centre and a convenient radius, draw an arc cutting l at C and BA at D
[Fig 10.2(iii)].
©
o
tt
no
Step 4 Now with A as centre and the same radius as in Step 3, draw an arc EF cutting AB
at G [Fig 10.2 (iv)].
2020-21
PRACTICAL GEOMETRY 195
Step 5 Place the pointed tip of the compasses at C and adjust the opening so that the
pencil tip is at D [Fig 10.2 (v)].
Step 6 With the same opening as in Step 5 and with G as centre, draw an arc cutting the
arc EF at H [Fig 10.2 (vi)].
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
Note that ∠ABC and ∠BAH are alternate interior angles. Fig 10.2 (i)–(vii)
Therefore m || l
1. In the above construction, can you draw any other line through A that would be also
parallel to the line l ?
2. Can you slightly modify the above construction to use the idea of equal corresponding
angles instead of equal alternate angles?
2020-21
196 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 10.1
1. Draw a line, say AB, take a point C outside it. Through C, draw a line parallel to AB
using ruler and compasses only.
2. Draw a line l. Draw a perpendicular to l at any point on l. On this perpendicular
choose a point X, 4 cm away from l. Through X, draw a line m parallel to l.
3. Let l be a line and P be a point not on l. Through P, draw a line m parallel to l. Now
join P to any point Q on l. Choose any other point R on m. Through R, draw a line
parallel to PQ. Let this meet l at S. What shape do the two sets of parallel lines enclose?
d
∠3 = ∠1 + ∠2 on triangles, in particular, the chapters on properties of triangles ∠1 + ∠2 + ∠3 = 180°
he
and congruence of triangles.
pu T
You know how triangles are classified based on sides or
is
re ER
angles and the following important properties concerning triangles:
bl
(i) The exterior angle of a triangle is equal in measure to the
be NC
hypotenuse is equal to the sum of the squares of the lengths of the other two
tt
sides.
no
In the chapter on ‘Congruence of Triangles’, we saw that a triangle can be drawn if any
one of the following sets of measurements are given:
(i) Three sides.
(ii) Two sides and the angle between them.
(iii) Two angles and the side between them.
(iv) The hypotenuse and a leg in the case of a right-angled triangle.
We will now attempt to use these ideas to construct triangles.
2020-21
PRACTICAL GEOMETRY 197
Step 1 First, we draw a rough sketch with given measure, (This will help us in
deciding how to proceed) [Fig 10.3(i)].
(i)
d
Step 3 From B, point A is at a distance of 5 cm. So, with B as centre, draw an arc of
he
radius 5 cm. (Now A will be somewhere on this arc. Our job is to find where
pu T
exactly A is) [Fig 10.3(iii)].
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
(iii)
no
Step 4 From C, point A is at a distance of 7 cm. So, with C as centre, draw an arc of
radius 7 cm. (A will be somewhere on this arc, we have to fix it) [Fig 10.3(iv)].
(iv)
2020-21
198 MATHEMATICS
Step 5 A has to be on both the arcs drawn. So, it is the point of intersection of arcs.
Mark the point of intersection of arcs as A. Join AB and AC. ∆ABC is now ready
[Fig 10.3(v)].
d
he
pu T (v)
Fig 10.3 (i) – (v)
is
re ER
DO THIS
bl
be NC
Now, let us construct another triangle DEF such that DE = 5 cm, EF = 6 cm, and
DF = 7 cm. Take a cutout of ∆DEF and place it on ∆ABC. What do we observe?
©
We observe that ∆DEF exactly coincides with ∆ABC. (Note that the triangles have
been constructed when their three sides are given.) Thus, if three sides of one triangle are
equal to the corresponding three sides of another triangle, then the two triangles are
o
congruent. This is SSS congruency rule which we have learnt in our earlier chapter.
tt
A student attempted to draw a triangle whose rough figure is given here. He drew QR first.
Then with Q as centre, he drew an arc of 3 cm and with R as centre, he drew an arc of
2 cm. But he could not get P. What is the reason? What property of
P triangle do you know in connection with this problem?
2 cm
3 cm Can such a triangle exist? (Remember the property of triangles
Q 6 cm R ‘The sum of any two sides of a traingle is always greater than the
third side’!)
Fig 10.4 Think: Is this right?
2020-21
PRACTICAL GEOMETRY 199
EXERCISE 10.2
1. Construct ∆XYZ in which XY = 4.5 cm, YZ = 5 cm and ZX = 6 cm.
2. Construct an equilateral triangle of side 5.5 cm.
3. Draw ∆PQR with PQ = 4 cm, QR = 3.5 cm and PR = 4 cm. What type of triangle
is this?
4. Construct ∆ABC such that AB = 2.5 cm, BC = 6 cm and AC = 6.5 cm. Measure ∠B.
d
Here, we have two sides given and the one angle between them. We first draw a sketch
he
and then draw one of the given line segments. The other steps follow. See Example 2.
pu T (Rough Sketch)
is
re ER
EXAMPLE 2 Construct a triangle PQR, given bl
that PQ = 3 cm, QR = 5.5 cm
and ∠PQR = 60°.
be NC
SOLUTION
Step 1 First, we draw a rough sketch with
©
2020-21
200 MATHEMATICS
(v)
Fig 10.5 (i) – (v)
d
DO THIS
he
pu T
Let us now construct another triangle ABC such that AB = 3 cm, BC = 5.5 cm and
is
re ER
m∠ABC = 60°. Take a cut out of ∆ABC and place it on ∆PQR.What do we observe?
We observe that ∆ABC exactly coincides with ∆PQR. Thus, if two sides and the included
bl
angle of one triangle are equal to the corresponding two sides and the included angle of
be NC
another triangle, then the two triangles are congruent. This is SAS congruency rule which
we have learnt in our earlier chapter. (Note that the triangles have been constructed when
their two sides and the angle included between these two sides are given.)
©
In the above construction, lengths of two sides and measure of one angle were given. Now
tt
EXERCISE 10.3
1. Construct ∆DEF such that DE = 5 cm, DF = 3 cm and m∠EDF = 90°.
2. Construct an isosceles triangle in which the lengths of each of its equal sides is 6.5 cm
and the angle between them is 110°.
3. Construct ∆ABC with BC = 7.5 cm, AC = 5 cm and m∠C = 60°.
2020-21
PRACTICAL GEOMETRY 201
SOLUTION
Step 1 Before actual construction, we draw
a rough sketch with measures marked
on it. (This is just to get an idea as
d
(i)
how to proceed)
he
[Fig 10.6(i)].
pu T
is
re ER
(ii)
Step 2 Draw XY of length 6 cm.
bl
be NC
2020-21
202 MATHEMATICS
DO THIS
Now, draw another ∆LMN, where m∠NLM = 30°, LM = 6 cm and
m∠NML = 100°. Take a cutout of ∆LMN and place it on the ∆XYZ. We observe
that ∆LMN exactly coincides with ∆XYZ. Thus, if two angles and the included
side of one triangle are equal to the corresponding two angles and the included side
of another triangle, then the two triangles are congruent. This is ASA congruency
rule which you have learnt in the earlier chapter. (Note that the triangles have been
constructed when two angles and the included side between these angles are given.)
d
he
In ∆ABC, if AC = 7 cm, m∠A = 60° and m∠B = 50°, can you draw the triangle?
pu T
(Angle-sum property of a triangle may help you!)
is
re ER
EXERCISE 10.4
bl
be NC
1. Construct ∆ABC, given m∠A = 60°, m∠B = 30° and AB = 5.8 cm.
2. Construct ∆PQR if PQ = 5 cm, m∠PQR = 105° and m∠QRP = 40°.
(Hint: Recall angle-sum property of a triangle).
©
3. Examine whether you can construct ∆DEF such that EF = 7.2 cm, m∠E = 110° and
m∠F = 80°. Justify your answer.
o
(RHS CRITERION)
(Rough Sketch)
Here it is easy to make the rough sketch. Now, draw a line as per the given side.
Make a right angle on one of its points. Use compasses to mark length of side and
hypotenuse of the triangle. Complete the triangle. Consider the following:
EXAMPLE 4 Construct ∆LMN, right-angled at M, given that LN = 5 cm and
MN = 3 cm.
(i) SOLUTION
Step 1 Draw a rough sketch and mark the measures. Remember to mark the
right angle [Fig 10.7(i)].
Step 2 Draw MN of length 3 cm.
[Fig 10.7(ii)]. (ii)
2020-21
PRACTICAL GEOMETRY 203
(iii)
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
(iv)
(v)
Fig 10.7 (i) – (v)
EXERCISE 10.5
1. Construct the right angled ∆PQR, where m∠Q = 90°, QR = 8cm and
PR = 10 cm.
2. Construct a right-angled triangle whose hypotenuse is 6 cm long and one of the legs
is 4 cm long.
3. Construct an isosceles right-angled triangle ABC, where m∠ACB = 90° and
AC = 6 cm.
2020-21
204 MATHEMATICS
Miscellaneous questions
Below are given the measures of certain sides and angles of triangles. Identify those
which cannot be constructed and, say why you cannot construct them. Construct rest of
the triangles.
Triangle Given measurements
1. ∆ABC m∠A = 85°; m∠B = 115°; AB = 5 cm.
2. ∆PQR m∠Q = 30°; m∠R = 60°; QR = 4.7 cm.
3. ∆ABC m∠A = 70°; m∠B = 50°; AC = 3 cm.
4. ∆LMN m∠L = 60°; m∠N = 120°; LM = 5 cm.
5. ∆ABC BC = 2 cm; AB = 4 cm; AC = 2 cm.
6. ∆PQR PQ = 3.5 cm.; QR = 4 cm.; PR = 3.5 cm.
d
7. ∆XYZ XY = 3 cm; YZ = 4 cm; XZ = 5 cm
he
8. ∆DEF DE = 4.5cm;
pu T EF = 5.5cm; DF = 4 cm.
is
re ER
WHAT
bl HAVE WE DISCUSSED?
In this Chapter, we looked into the methods of some ruler and compasses constructions.
be NC
1. Given a line l and a point not on it, we used the idea of ‘equal alternate angles’ in a
transversal diagram to draw a line parallel to l.
We could also have used the idea of ‘equal corresponding angles’ to do the
©
construction.
2. We studied the method of drawing a triangle, using indirectly the concept of congruence
of triangles.
o
(ii) SAS: Given the lengths of any two sides and the measure of the
angle between these sides.
(iii) ASA: Given the measures of two angles and the length of side
included between them.
(iv) RHS: Given the length of hypotenuse of a right-angled triangle and
the length of one of its legs.
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 205
Chapter 11
Perimeter and
Area
d
11.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
In Class VI, you have already learnt perimeters of plane figures and areas of squares and
is
re ER
rectangles. Perimeter is the distance around a closed figure while area is the part of plane or
bl
region occupied by the closed figure.
be NC
In this class, you will learn about perimeters and areas of a few more plane figures.
Ayush and Deeksha made pictures. Ayush made his picture on a rectangular sheet of length
60 cm and breadth 20 cm while Deeksha made hers on a rectangular sheet of length 40 cm
and breadth 35 cm. Both these pictures have to be separately framed and laminated.
o
Who has to pay more for framing, if the cost of framing is ` 3.00 per cm?
tt
If the cost of lamination is ` 2.00 per cm2, who has to pay more for lamination?
no
For finding the cost of framing, we need to find perimeter and then multiply it by the rate
for framing. For finding the cost of lamination, we need to find area and then multiply it by the
rate for lamination.
TRY THESE
What would you need to find, area or perimeter, to answer the following?
1. How much space does a blackboard occupy?
2. What is the length of a wire required to fence a rectangular flower bed?
3. What distance would you cover by taking two rounds of a triangular park?
4. How much plastic sheet do you need to cover a rectangular swimming pool?
Do you remember,
Perimeter of a regular polygon = number of sides × length of one side
Perimeter of a square = 4 × side
2020-21
206 MATHEMATICS
Perimeter of a rectangle = 2 × (l + b)
Area of a rectangle = l × b, Area of a square = side × side
Tanya needed a square of side 4 cm for completing a collage. She had a
rectangular sheet of length 28 cm and breadth 21 cm (Fig 11. 1). She cuts off
Fig 11.1 a square of side 4 cm from the rectangular sheet. Her friend saw the remaining
A D sheet (Fig 11.2) and asked Tanya, “Has the perimeter of the sheet increased
or decreased now?”
Has the total length of side AD increased after cutting off the square?
Has the area increased or decreased?
B Fig 11.2 C
Tanya cuts off one more square from the opposite side (Fig 11.3).
A D
Will the perimeter of the remaining sheet increase further?
Will the area increase or decrease further?
d
So, what can we infer from this?
he
B Fig 11.3
pu T
C It is clear that the increase of perimeter need not lead to increase in area.
is
re ER
bl
TRY THESE
be NC
1. Experiment with several such shapes and cut-outs. You might find it useful to draw
these shapes on squared sheets and compute their areas and perimeters.
You have seen that increase in perimeter does not mean that area will also increase.
©
2. Give two examples where the area increases as the perimeter increases.
3. Give two examples where the area does not increase when perimeter increases.
o
tt
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 207
d
Cost of fencing = ` 150 × 44 = ` 6,600.
he
pu T Fig 11.5
EXAMPLE 4 A wire is in the shape of a square of side 10 cm. If the wire is
is
re ER
rebent into a rectangle of length 12 cm, find its breadth. Which encloses
bl
more area, the square or the rectangle?
be NC
Thus, 40 = 2 (12 + b)
tt
40
no
or = 12 + b
2
Therefore, b = 20 − 12 = 8 cm
The breadth of the rectangle is 8 cm.
Area of the square = (side)2
= 10 cm × 10 cm = 100 cm2
Area of the rectangle = l × b
= 12 cm × 8 cm = 96 cm2
So, the square encloses more area even though its perimeter is the same as that of the rectangle.
EXAMPLE 5 The area of a square and a rectangle are equal. If the side of the square is
40 cm and the breadth of the rectangle is 25 cm, find the length of the
rectangle. Also, find the perimeter of the rectangle.
S OLUTION Area of square = (side)2
= 40 cm × 40 cm = 1600 cm2
2020-21
208 MATHEMATICS
It is given that,
The area of the rectangle = The area of the square
Area of the rectangle = 1600 cm2, breadth of the rectangle = 25 cm.
Area of the rectangle = l × b
or 1600 = l × 25
1600
or =l or l = 64 cm
25
So, the length of rectangle is 64 cm.
Perimeter of the rectangle = 2 (l + b) = 2 (64 + 25) cm
= 2 × 89 cm = 178 cm
d
So, the perimeter of the rectangle is 178 cm even though its area is the same as that of
he
the square. pu T
is
re ER
bl EXERCISE 11.1
be NC
1. The length and the breadth of a rectangular piece of land are 500 m and 300 m
respectively. Find
(i) its area (ii) the cost of the land, if 1 m2 of the land costs ` 10,000.
©
4. The perimeter of a rectangular sheet is 100 cm. If the length is 35 cm, find its breadth.
no
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 209
d
2
he
1 1
= × (l × b) = (8 × 5)
pu T
2 2
is
re ER
40
=
bl
= 20 cm 2
2 Fig 11.8
be NC
Take a square of side 5 cm and divide it into 4 triangles as shown (Fig 11.8).
Are the four triangles equal in area?
Are they congruent to each other? (Superpose the triangles to check).
©
4
tt
1 1
(side)2 = (5)2 cm 2 = 6.25 cm2
no
=
4 4
2020-21
210 MATHEMATICS
TRY THESE
Each of the following rectangles of length 6 cm and breadth 4 cm is composed of
congruent polygons. Find the area of each polygon.
d
We come across many shapes other than squares and rectangles.
he
How will you find the area of a land which is a parallelogram in shape?
pu T
Let us find a method to get the area of a parallelogram.
is
re ER
Can a parallelogram be converted into a rectangle of equal area?
Draw a parallelogram on a graph paper as shown in Fig 11.10(i). Cut out the
bl
parallelogram. Draw a line from one vertex of the parallelogram perpendicular to the
be NC
opposite side [Fig 11.10(ii)]. Cut out the triangle. Move the triangle to the other side of
the parallelogram.
©
o
tt
no
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 211
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
Fig 11.12
o
Find the areas of the parallelograms by counting the squares enclosed within the figures
tt
You will find that all these parallelograms have equal areas but different perimeters. Now,
2020-21
212 MATHEMATICS
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
Fig 11.13
Find the perimeter and area of each of these parallelograms. Analyse your results.
©
You will find that these parallelograms have different areas but equal perimeters.
To find the area of a parallelogram, you need to know only the base and the
corresponding height of the parallelogram.
o
tt
TRY THESE
no
(i) (ii)
(iii) In a parallelogram ABCD, AB = 7.2 cm and the perpendicular from C on AB is 4.5 cm.
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 213
d
Compare the base and height of the triangles with the base
he
and height of the parallelogram. pu T
is
You will find that the sum of the areas of both the triangles
re ER
is equal to the area of the parallelogram. The base and the
bl
height of the triangle are the same as the base and the height of
be NC
1
= (base × height) (Since area of a parallelogram = base × height)
2
1 1
o
= (b × h) (or bh , in short)
tt
2 2
no
TRY THESE
1. Try the above activity with different types of triangles.
2. Take different parallelograms. Divide each of the parallelograms into two triangles by
cutting along any of its diagonals. Are the triangles congruent?
In the figure (Fig 11.15) all the triangles are on the base AB = 6 cm.
What can you say about the height of each of the triangles
corresponding to the base AB?
Can we say all the triangles are equal in area? Yes.
Are the triangles congruent also? No.
We conclude that all the congruent triangles are equal in
6 cm
area but the triangles equal in area need not be congruent. Fig 11.15
2020-21
214 MATHEMATICS
D B 6 cm C
EXAMPLE 6 One of the sides and the corresponding height of a
parallelogram are 4 cm and 3 cm respectively. Find the
area of the parallelogram (Fig 11.17).
Fig 11.16
SOLUTION Given that length of base (b) = 4 cm, height (h) = 3 cm
Area of the parallelogram = b × h
= 4 cm × 3 cm = 12 cm2
d
EXAMPLE 7 Find the height ‘x’ if the area of the
he
parallelogram is 24 cm2 and the base is
pu T Fig 11.17
4 cm.
is
re ER
SOLUTION Area of parallelogram = b × h
bl
be NC
(i) area of the parallelogram. (ii) the height corresponding to the base AD.
no
SOLUTION
(i) Area of parallelogram = b × h
= 6 cm × 3 cm = 18 cm2
(ii) base (b) = 4 cm, height = x (say),
Area = 18 cm2
Area of parallelogram = b × x A B
18 = 4 × x x
m
3 cm
18
4c
=x
4
D C
Therefore, x = 4.5 cm 6 cm
Thus, the height corresponding to base AD is 4.5 cm. Fig 11.19
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 215
S
(i) Fig 11.20 (ii)
SOLUTION
1 1
(i) Area of triangle = bh = × QR × PS
2 2
d
1
he
= × 4 cm × 2 cm = 4 cm2
2 pu T
is
re ER
1 1
(ii) Area of triangle = bh = × MN × LO
bl
2 2
be NC
1
= × 3 cm × 2 cm = 3 cm2
2
EXAMPLE 10 Find BC, if the area of the triangle ABC is 36 cm2 and the height AD is
©
3 cm (Fig 11.21).
SOLUTION Height = 3 cm, Area = 36 cm2
o
1
tt
1 36 × 2
or 36 = ×b×3 i.e., b = = 24 cm Fig 11.21
2 3
So, BC = 24 cm
EXAMPLE 11 In ∆PQR, PR = 8 cm, QR = 4 cm and PL = 5 cm (Fig 11.22). Find:
(i) the area of the ∆PQR (ii) QM
SOLUTION
(i) QR = base = 4 cm, PL = height = 5 cm
1
Area of the triangle PQR = bh
2
1
= × 4 cm × 5 cm = 10 cm2
2 Fig 11.22
2020-21
216 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 11.2
1. Find the area of each of the following parallelograms:
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
(a)
bl (b) (c)
be NC
©
(d) (e)
2. Find the area of each of the following triangles:
o
tt
no
a. 20 cm 246 cm2
b. 15 cm 154.5 cm2
c. 8.4 cm 48.72 cm2
d. 15.6 cm 16.38 cm2
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 217
15 cm ______ 87 cm2
d
he
6. DL and BM are the heights on sides AB and AD respectively of
pu T
parallelogram ABCD (Fig 11.24). If the area of the parallelogram
is
re ER
is 1470 cm2, AB = 35 cm and AD = 49 cm, find the length of BM
bl
and DL. Fig 11.24
7. ∆ABC is right angled at A (Fig 11.25). AD is perpendicular to BC. If AB = 5 cm,
be NC
BC = 13 cm and AC = 12 cm, Find the area of ∆ABC. Also find the length of
AD.
©
o
tt
no
11.5 CIRCLES
A racing track is semi-circular at both ends (Fig 11.27).
Can you find the distance covered by an athlete if he takes two rounds
of a racing track? We need to find a method to find the distances around
when a shape is circular.
Fig 11.27
11.5.1 Circumference of a Circle
Tanya cut different cards, in curved shape from a cardboard. She wants to put lace around
2020-21
218 MATHEMATICS
to decorate these cards. What length of the lace does she require for each? (Fig 11.28)
d
Fig 11.29 point on the table also (Fig 11. 29).
he
Now roll the circular card on the table along a straight line till
pu T
the marked point again touches the table. Measure the distance
is
re ER
along the line. This is the length of the lace required
bl
(Fig 11.30). It is also the distance along the edge of the card
be NC
DO THIS
o
Take a bottle cap, a bangle or any other circular object and find the circumference.
tt
Now, can you find the distance covered by the athlete on the track by this method?
no
Still, it will be very difficult to find the distance around the track or any other circular
object by measuring through string. Moreover, the measurement will not be accurate.
So, we need some formula for this, as we have for rectilinear figures or shapes.
Let us see if there is any relationship between the diameter and the circumference of
the circles.
Consider the following table: Draw six circles of different radii and find their circumference
by using string. Also find the ratio of the circumference to the diameter.
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 219
44
2. 7.0 cm 14.0 cm 44.0 cm = 3.14
14
66
3. 10.5 cm 21.0 cm 66.0 cm = 3.14
21
132
4. 21.0 cm 42.0 cm 132.0 cm = 3.14
42
32
5. 5.0 cm 10.0 cm 32.0 cm = 3.2
10
94
6. 15.0 cm 30.0 cm 94.0 cm = 3.13
30
What do you infer from the above table? Is this ratio approximately the same? Yes.
d
Can you say that the circumference of a circle is always more than three times its
he
diameter? Yes. pu T
is
re ER
22
This ratio is a constant and is denoted by π (pi). Its approximate value is
bl or 3.14.
7
be NC
C
So, we can say that = π , where ‘C’ represents circumference of the circle and ‘d’
d
its diameter.
©
or C = πd
We know that diameter (d) of a circle is twice the radius (r) i.e., d = 2r
So, C = πd = π × 2r or C = 2πr.
o
tt
TRY THESE
no
In Fig 11.31,
(a) Which square has the larger perimeter?
(b) Which is larger, perimeter of smaller square or the
circumference of the circle? Fig 11.31
DO THIS
Take one each of quarter plate and half plate. Roll once each of these on
a table-top. Which plate covers more distance in one complete revolution?
Which plate will take less number of revolutions to cover the length of the
table-top?
2020-21
220 MATHEMATICS
d
Circumference of disc = 2πr
he
22
pu T = 2× × 14 cm = 88 cm
7
is
re ER
So, the circumference of the circular disc is 88 cm.
bl
EXAMPLE 14 The radius of a circular pipe is 10 cm. What length of a tape is required
be NC
= 62.8 cm
tt
Therefore, length of the tape needed to wrap once around the pipe is 62.8 cm.
no
22
EXAMPLE 15 Find the perimeter of the given shape (Fig 11.32) (Take π = ).
7
SOLUTION In this shape we need to find the circumference of semicircles on each side
of the square. Do you need to find the perimeter of the square also? No.
The outer boundary, of this figure is made up of semicircles. Diameter of
each semicircle is 14 cm.
We know that:
Circumference of the circle = πd
1 14 cm
Circumference of the semicircle = πd
2
14 cm
1 22
= × × 14 cm = 22 cm
2 7
Circumference of each of the semicircles is 22 cm
Therefore, perimeter of the given figure = 4 × 22 cm = 88 cm Fig 11.32
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 221
d
Thus, perimeter of each semicircular disc = 22 cm + 14 cm = 36 cm
he
11.5.2 Area of Circle
pu T
is
re ER
Consider the following: bl
l A farmer dug a flower bed of radius 7 m at the centre of a field. He needs to
purchase fertiliser. If 1 kg of fertiliser is required for 1 square metre area,
be NC
Can you tell what we need to find in such cases, Area or Perimeter? In such
cases we need to find the area of the circular region. Let us find the area of a circle, using
graph paper.
o
Draw a circle of radius 4 cm on a graph paper (Fig 11.34). Find the area by counting
tt
As the edges are not straight, we get a rough estimate of the area of circle by this method.
There is another way of finding the area of a circle.
Fig 11.34
Draw a circle and shade one half of the circle [Fig 11.35(i)]. Now fold the circle into
eighths and cut along the folds [Fig 11.35(ii)].
(i) (ii)
Fig 11.36
Fig 11.35
Arrange the separate pieces as shown, in Fig 11.36, which is roughly a parallelogram.
The more sectors we have, the nearer we reach an appropriate parallelogram.
2020-21
222 MATHEMATICS
As done above if we divide the circle in 64 sectors, and arrange these sectors. It
gives nearly a rectangle (Fig 11.37).
Fig 11.37
What is the breadth of this rectangle? The breadth of this rectangle is the radius of the
circle, i.e., ‘r’.
As the whole circle is divided into 64 sectors and on each side we have 32 sectors, the
d
length of the rectangle is the length of the 32 sectors, which is half of the circumference.
he
(Fig 11.37) pu T
Area of the circle = Area of rectangle thus formed = l × b
is
re ER
1
bl
= (Half of circumference) × radius = × 2πr × r = πr2
2
be NC
TRY THESE
©
Draw circles of different radii on a graph paper. Find the area by counting the
number of squares. Also find the area by using the formula. Compare the two answers.
o
SOLUTION Radius, r = 30 cm
no
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 223
SOLUTION
(a) Radius of the larger circle = 10 cm
So, area of the larger circle = πr 2
= 3.14 × 10 × 10 = 314 cm2
(b) Radius of the smaller circle = 4 cm
Area of the smaller circle = πr 2
= 3.14 × 4 × 4 = 50.24 cm2
(c) Area of the shaded region = (314 – 50.24) cm2 = 263.76 cm2
EXERCISE 11.3
22
1. Find the circumference of the circles with the following radius: (Take π = )
7
d
(a) 14 cm (b) 28 mm (c) 21 cm
he
2. Find the area of the following circles, given that:
pu T
22
is
re ER
(a) radius = 14 mm (Take π = ) (b) diameter = 49 m
7 bl
(c) radius = 5 cm
be NC
3. If the circumference of a circular sheet is 154 m, find its radius. Also find the area of
22
the sheet. (Take π = )
7
4. A gardener wants to fence a circular garden of diameter 21m. Find the length of the
©
rope he needs to purchase, if he makes 2 rounds of fence. Also find the cost of the
22
rope, if it costs ` 4 per meter. (Take π = )
7
5. From a circular sheet of radius 4 cm, a circle of radius 3 cm is removed. Find the area
o
6. Saima wants to put a lace on the edge of a circular table cover of diameter 1.5 m.
no
Find the length of the lace required and also find its cost if one meter of the lace costs
` 15. (Take π = 3.14)
7. Find the perimeter of the adjoining figure, which is a semicircle including
its diameter.
8. Find the cost of polishing a circular table-top of diameter 1.6 m, if
the rate of polishing is ` 15/m2. (Take π = 3.14)
9. Shazli took a wire of length 44 cm and bent it into the shape of a circle.
Find the radius of that circle. Also find its area. If the same wire is bent into the shape
of a square, what will be the length of each of its sides? Which figure encloses more
22
area, the circle or the square? (Take π = )
7
10. From a circular card sheet of radius 14 cm, two circles of radius 3.5 cm and a
rectangle of length 3 cm and breadth 1cm are removed. (as shown in the adjoining
22
figure). Find the area of the remaining sheet. (Take π = )
7
2020-21
224 MATHEMATICS
11. A circle of radius 2 cm is cut out from a square piece of an aluminium sheet of side
6 cm. What is the area of the left over aluminium sheet? (Take π = 3.14)
12. The circumference of a circle is 31.4 cm. Find the radius and the area of the circle?
(Take π = 3.14)
13. A circular flower bed is surrounded by a path 4 m wide. The diameter of the flower
bed is 66 m. What is the area of this path? (π = 3.14)
66m
14. A circular flower garden has an area of 314 m2. A sprinkler at the centre of the
garden can cover an area that has a radius of 12 m. Will the sprinkler water the entire
garden? (Take π = 3.14)
15. Find the circumference of the inner and the outer circles, shown in the adjoining figure?
(Take π = 3.14)
d
22
16. How many times a wheel of radius 28 cm must rotate to go 352 m? (Take π = )
he
7
pu T
17. The minute hand of a circular clock is 15 cm long. How far does the tip of the minute
is
re ER
hand move in 1 hour. (Take π = 3.14)
bl
11.6 CONVERSION UNITS
be NC
OF
We know that 1 cm = 10 mm. Can you tell 1 cm2 is equal to how many mm2? Let us explore
similar questions and find how to convert units while measuring areas to another unit.
©
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 225
But when we convert a unit of area to a larger unit, the number of larger units will be
smaller.
1000 2
For example, 1000 cm2 = m = 0.1 m2
10000
TRY THESE
Convert the following:
(i) 50 cm2 in mm2 (ii) 2 ha in m2 (iii) 10 m2 in cm2 (iv) 1000 cm2 in m2
11.7 APPLICATIONS
You must have observed that quite often, in gardens or parks, some space is left all around
in the form of path or in between as cross paths. A framed picture has some space left all
d
around it.
he
We need to find the areas of such pathways or borders when
we want to find the cost of making them.
pu T P 2.5 m Q
is
re ER
A 45 m B
EXAMPLE 20 A rectangular park is 45 m long and 30 m wide.
bl
A path 2.5 m wide is constructed outside the
2.5 m
be NC
2020-21
226 MATHEMATICS
250
Therefore, cost of cementing 1 m2 = `
10
250
So, cost of cementing 1900 m2 = ` × 1900 = ` 47,500
10
EXAMPLE 22 Two cross roads, each of width 5 m, run at right angles through the centre
of a rectangular park of length 70 m and breadth 45 m and parallel to its
sides. Find the area of the roads. Also find the cost of constructing the
roads at the rate of ` 105 per m2.
SOLUTION Area of the cross roads is the area of shaded portion, i.e., the area of
the rectangle PQRS and the area of the rectangle EFGH. But while
doing this, the area of the square KLMN is taken twice,
d
which is to be subtracted.
he
pu T Now, PQ = 5 m and PS = 45 m
is
re ER
EH = 5 m and EF = 70 m
bl KL = 5 m and KN = 5 m
Area of the path = Area of the rectangle PQRS + area of
be NC
EXERCISE 11.4
no
2020-21
PERIMETER AND AREA 227
6. Two cross roads, each of width 10 m, cut at right angles through the centre of a
rectangular park of length 700 m and breadth 300 m and parallel to its sides. Find the
area of the roads. Also find the area of the park excluding cross roads. Give the
answer in hectares.
7. Through a rectangular field of length 90 m and breadth 60 m, two roads are
constructed which are parallel to the sides and cut each other at right angles through
the centre of the fields. If the width of each road is 3 m, find
(i) the area covered by the roads.
(ii) the cost of constructing the roads at the rate of ` 110 per m2.
8. Pragya wrapped a cord around a circular pipe of radius 4 cm (adjoining figure) and
cut off the length required of the cord. Then she wrapped it around a square box of
side 4 cm (also shown). Did she have any cord left? (π = 3.14)
d
9. The adjoining figure represents a rectangular lawn with a circular flower bed in the
he
middle. Find:
pu T
(i) the area of the whole land (ii) the area of the flower bed
is
re ER
(iii) the area of the lawn excluding the area of the flower bed
bl
(iv) the circumference of the flower bed.
be NC
10. In the following figures, find the area of the shaded portions:
©
o
tt
no
(i) (ii)
11. Find the area of the quadrilateral ABCD.
Here, AC = 22 cm, BM = 3 cm,
DN = 3 cm, and
BM ⊥ AC, DN ⊥ AC
2020-21
228 MATHEMATICS
d
4. Area of a triangle = (area of the parallelogram generated from it)
2
he
=
pu T
1
× base × height
is
re ER
2
bl
5. The distance around a circular region is known as its circumference.
be NC
22
Circumference of a circle = πd, where d is the diameter of a circle and π =
7
or 3.14 (approximately).
©
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 229
Chapter 12
Algebraic
Expressions
d
12.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
We have already come across simple algebraic expressions like x + 3, y – 5, 4x + 5,
is
re ER
10y – 5 and so on. In Class VI, we have seen how these expressions are useful in formulating
bl
puzzles and problems. We have also seen examples of several expressions in the chapter on
simple equations.
be NC
We now know very well what a variable is. We use letters x, y, l, m, ... etc. to denote
variables. A variable can take various values. Its value is not fixed. On the other hand, a
no
constant has a fixed value. Examples of constants are: 4, 100, –17, etc.
We combine variables and constants to make algebraic expressions. For this, we use the
operations of addition, subtraction, multiplication and division. We have already come across
expressions like 4x + 5, 10y – 20. The expression 4x + 5 is obtained from the variable x, first
by multiplying x by the constant 4 and then adding the constant 5 to the product. Similarly,
10y – 20 is obtained by first multiplying y by 10 and then subtracting 20 from the product.
The above expressions were obtained by combining variables with constants. We can
also obtain expressions by combining variables with themselves or with other variables.
Look at how the following expressions are obtained:
x2, 2y2, 3x2 – 5, xy, 4xy + 7
(i) The expression x2 is obtained by multiplying the variable x by itself;
x × x = x2
Just as 4 × 4 is written as 42, we write x × x = x2. It is commonly read as x squared.
2020-21
230 MATHEMATICS
(Later, when you study the chapter ‘Exponents and Powers’ you will realise that x2
may also be read as x raised to the power 2).
In the same manner, we can write x × x × x = x3
Commonly, x3 is read as ‘x cubed’. Later, you will realise that x3 may also be read
as x raised to the power 3.
x, x2, x3, ... are all algebraic expressions obtained from x.
(ii) The expression 2y 2 is obtained from y: 2y 2 = 2 × y × y
Here by multiplying y with y we obtain y 2 and then we multiply y2 by the constant 2.
(iii) In (3x2 – 5) we first obtain x2, and multiply it by 3 to get 3x2.
TRY THESE From 3x2, we subtract 5 to finally arrive at 3x2 – 5.
Describe how the (iv) In xy, we multiply the variable x with another variable y. Thus,
following expressions x × y = xy.
d
are obtained:
he
(v) In 4xy + 7, we first obtain xy, multiply it by 4 to get 4xy and add
7xy + 5, x2y, 4x2 – 5x pu T
7 to 4xy to get the expression.
is
re ER
12.3 TERMS OF AN
bl EXPRESSION
be NC
We shall now put in a systematic form what we have learnt above about how expressions
are formed. For this purpose, we need to understand what terms of an expression and
their factors are.
Consider the expression (4x + 5). In forming this expression, we first formed 4x
©
separately as a product of 4 and x and then added 5 to it. Similarly consider the expression
(3x2 + 7y). Here we first formed 3x2 separately as a product of 3, x and x. We then
formed 7y separately as a product of 7 and y. Having formed 3x2 and 7y separately, we
o
You will find that the expressions we deal with can always be seen this way. They
no
have parts which are formed separately and then added. Such parts of an expression
which are formed separately first and then added are known as terms. Look at the
expression (4x2 – 3xy). We say that it has two terms, 4x2 and –3xy. The term 4x2 is a
product of 4, x and x, and the term (–3xy) is a product of (–3), x and y.
Terms are added to form expressions. Just as the terms 4x and 5 are added to
form the expression (4x + 5), the terms 4x2 and (–3xy) are added to give the expression
(4x2 – 3xy). This is because 4x2 + (–3xy) = 4x2 – 3xy.
Note, the minus sign (–) is included in the term. In the expression 4x2 –3xy, we
took the term as (–3xy) and not as (3xy). That is why we do not need to say that
terms are ‘added or subtracted’ to form an expression; just ‘added’ is enough.
Factors of a term
We saw above that the expression (4x2 – 3xy) consists of two terms 4x2 and –3xy. The
term 4x2 is a product of 4, x and x; we say that 4, x and x are the factors of the term 4x2.
A term is a product of its factors. The term –3xy is a product of the factors –3, x and y.
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 231
d
Similarly, if x3 were a term, it would be written as
he
x × x × x and not x 2 × x. Also, remember that
pu T
1 is not taken as a separate factor.
is
re ER
Coefficients
bl
be NC
It is also said to be the coefficient of the rest of the term (which following expressions?
is obviously the product of algebraic factors of the term). Thus Show how the terms are
in 5xy, 5 is the coefficient of the term. It is also the coefficient formed. Draw a tree diagram
o
of xy. In the term 10xyz, 10 is the coefficient of xyz, in the for each expression:
tt
2020-21
232 MATHEMATICS
S OLUTION
S. No. Expression Term (which is not Numerical
a Constant) Coefficient
(i) xy + 4 xy 1
(ii) 13 – y2 – y2 –1
(iii) 13 – y + 5y2 –y –1
5y2 5
(iv) 4p2q – 3pq2 + 5 4p2q 4
– 3pq2 –3
EXAMPLE 2
d
(a) What are the coefficients of x in the following expressions?
he
4x – 3y, 8 – x + y, y2x – y, 2z – 5xz
pu T
(b) What are the coefficients of y in the following expressions?
is
re ER
4x – 3y, 8 + yz, yz2 + 5, my + m
bl
SOLUTION
be NC
(a) In each expression we look for a term with x as a factor. The remaining part of that
term is the coefficient of x.
©
2 2
(iii) yx–y yx y2
tt
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 233
d
monomial. The expression (a + b + 5) is not a binomial. expressions as a monomial,
he
It contains three terms.
pu T a binomial or a trinomial: a,
a + b, ab + a + b, ab + a
is
re ER
An expression which contains three terms is called a
bl + b – 5, xy, xy + 5,
trinomial; for example, the expressions x + y + 7, ab + a +b,
5x2 – x + 2, 4pq – 3q + 5p,
3x2 – 5x + 2, m + n + 10 are trinomials. The expression
be NC
7, 4m – 7n + 10, 4mn + 7.
ab + a + b + 5 is, however not a trinomial; it contains four
terms and not three. The expression x + y + 5x is not a trinomial as the terms x and 5x are
like terms.
©
(i) 7x, 12y (ii) 15x, –21x (iii) – 4ab, 7ba (iv) 3xy, 3x
no
2020-21
234 MATHEMATICS
Following simple steps will help you to decide whether the given terms are like
or unlike terms:
(i) Ignore the numerical coefficients. Concentrate on the algebraic part of the
d
terms.
he
(ii) Check the variables in the terms. They must be the same.
pu T
(iii) Next, check the powers of each variable in the terms. They must be the same.
is
re ER
Note that in deciding like terms, two things do not matter (1) the numerical
bl
coefficients of the terms and (2) the order in which the variables are multiplied in the
be NC
terms.
EXERCISE 12.1
©
1. Get the algebraic expressions in the following cases using variables, constants and
arithmetic operations.
(i) Subtraction of z from y.
o
tt
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 235
3 1
(g) x+ (h) 0.1 p2 + 0.2 q2
4 4
3. Identify the numerical coefficients of terms (other than constants) in the following
expressions:
(i) 5 – 3t2 (ii) 1 + t + t2 + t3 (iii) x + 2xy + 3y
2 2
(iv) 100m + 1000n (v) – p q + 7pq (vi) 1.2 a + 0.8 b
2
(vii) 3.14 r (viii) 2 (l + b) (ix) 0.1 y + 0.01 y2
4. (a) Identify terms which contain x and give the coefficient of x.
(i) y2x + y (ii) 13y2 – 8yx (iii) x + y + 2
(iv) 5 + z + zx (v) 1 + x + xy (vi) 12xy2 + 25
(vii) 7x + xy2
d
(b) Identify terms which contain y2 and give the coefficient of y2.
he
(i) 8 – xy2 (ii) 5y2 + 7x
pu T (iii) 2x2y – 15xy2 + 7y2
5. Classify into monomials, binomials and trinomials.
is
re ER
(i) 4y – 7z (ii) y2 bl (iii) x + y – xy (iv) 100
2 2
(v) ab – a – b (vi) 5 – 3t (vii) 4p q – 4pq (viii) 7mn
be NC
2 2 2 2
(ix) z – 3z + 8 (x) a + b (xi) z + z
(xii) 1 + x + x2
6. State whether a given pair of terms is of like or unlike terms.
©
5
(i) 1, 100 (ii) –7x, x (iii) – 29x, – 29y
2
(iv) 14xy, 42yx (v) 4m2p, 4mp2 (vi) 12xz, 12x2z2
o
(a) – xy2, – 4yx2, 8x2, 2xy2, 7y, – 11x2, – 100x, – 11yx, 20x2y,
no
– 6x2, y, 2xy, 3x
(b) 10pq, 7p, 8q, – p2q2, – 7qp, – 100q, – 23, 12q2p2, – 5p2, 41, 2405p, 78qp,
13p2q, qp2, 701p2
2020-21
236 MATHEMATICS
marbles and Ameena’s marbles, and to this sum add 3, that is, we take the sum of
x, x + 10 and 3.
2. Ramu’s father’s present age is 3 times Ramu’s age. Ramu’s grandfather’s age is 13
years more than the sum of Ramu’s age and Ramu’s father’s age. How do you find
Ramu’s grandfather’s age?
Since Ramu’s age is not given, let us take it to be y years. Then his father’s age is
3y years. To find Ramu’s grandfather’s age we have to take the sum of Ramu’s age (y)
and his father’s age (3y) and to the sum add 13, that is, we have to take the sum of
y, 3y and 13.
3. In a garden, roses and marigolds are planted in square plots. The length of the
square plot in which marigolds are planted is 3 metres greater than the length of the
square plot in which roses are planted. How much bigger in area is the marigold plot
than the rose plot?
d
Let us take l metres to be length of the side of the rose plot. The length of the side of
he
the marigold plot will be (l + 3) metres. Their respective areas will be l2 and (l + 3)2.
pu T
The difference between (l 2 + 3)2 and l 2 will decide how much bigger in area the
is
re ER
marigold plot is. bl
In all the three situations, we had to carry out addition or subtraction of algebraic
be NC
expressions. There are a number of real life problems in which we need to use
expressions and do arithmetic operations on them. In this section, we shall see how
algebraic expressions are added and subtracted.
©
TRY THESE
Think of atleast two situations in each of which you need to form two algebraic
o
The simplest expressions are monomials. They consist of only one term. To begin with we
shall learn how to add or subtract like terms.
l Let us add 3x and 4x. We know x is a number and so also are 3x and 4x.
Now, 3x + 4x = (3 × x) + (4 × x)
= (3 + 4) × x (using distributive law)
= 7 × x = 7x
Since variables are numbers, we can
or 3x + 4x = 7x use distributive law for them.
l Let us next add 8xy, 4xy and 2xy
8xy + 4xy + 2xy = (8 × xy) + (4 × xy) + (2 × xy)
= (8 + 4 + 2) × xy
= 14 × xy = 14xy
or 8xy + 4xy + 2xy = 14 xy
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 237
d
like terms.
he
Note, unlike terms cannot be added or subtracted the way like terms are added
pu T
is
re ER
or subtracted. We have already seen examples of this, when 5 is added to x, we write the
bl
result as (x + 5). Observe that in (x + 5) both the terms 5 and x are retained.
be NC
Similarly, if we add the unlike terms 3xy and 7, the sum is 3xy + 7.
If we subtract 7 from 3xy, the result is 3xy – 7
©
The sum = 3x + 11 + 7x – 5
no
Now, we know that the terms 3x and 7x are like terms and so also are 11 and – 5.
Further 3x + 7x = 10 x and 11 + (– 5) = 6. We can, therefore, simplify the sum as:
The sum = 3x + 11 + 7x – 5
= 3x + 7x + 11 – 5 (rearranging terms)
= 10x + 6
Hence, 3x + 11 + 7x – 5 = 10x + 6
l Add 3x + 11 + 8z and 7x – 5.
The sum = 3x + 11 + 8z + 7x – 5
= 3x + 7x + 11 – 5 + 8z (rearranging terms)
Note we have put like terms together; the single unlike term 8z will remain as it is.
Therefore, the sum = 10x + 6 + 8z
2020-21
238 MATHEMATICS
l Subtract a – b from 3a – b + 4
The difference = 3a – b + 4 – (a – b) Note, just as
= 3a – b + 4 – a + b – (5 – 3) = – 5 + 3,
Observe how we took (a – b) in brackets and took – (a – b) = – a + b.
care of signs in opening the bracket. Rearranging the The signs of algebraic
terms to put like terms together, terms are handled in the
same way as signs of
The difference = 3a – a + b – b + 4 numbers.
= (3 – 1) a + (1 – 1) b + 4
The difference = 2a + (0) b + 4 = 2a + 4
or 3a – b + 4 – (a – b) = 2a + 4
d
We shall now solve some more examples on addition and subtraction of expression
he
for practice. pu T
is
re ER
EXAMPLE 4 Collect like terms and simplify the expression:
bl
12m2 – 9m + 5m – 4m2 – 7m + 10
be NC
TRY THESE
Add and subtract = 8m2 + (– 4 – 7) m + 10
(i) m – n, m + n = 8m2 + (–11) m + 10
o
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 239
EXAMPLE 6 From the sum of 2y2 + 3yz, – y2 – yz – z2 and yz + 2z2, subtract the
sum of 3y2 – z2 and –y2 + yz + z2.
d
2
2y + yz (2)
he
Now we subtract sum (2) from the sum (1):
pu T
is
re ER
y2 + 3yz + z2
2y2 + yz
bl
be NC
– –
– y2 + 2yz + z2
EXERCISE 12.2
©
2020-21
240 MATHEMATICS
d
(viii) 4pq – 5q2 – 3p2 from 5p2 + 3q2 – pq
he
pu T
4. (a) What should be added to x2 + xy + y2 to obtain 2x2 + 3xy?
is
re ER
(b) What should be subtracted from 2a + 8b + 10 to get – 3a + 7b + 16?
bl
5. What should be taken away from 3x 2 – 4y 2 + 5xy + 20 to obtain
be NC
– x2 – y2 + 6xy + 20?
6. (a) From the sum of 3x – y + 11 and – y – 11, subtract 3x – y – 11.
(b) From the sum of 4 + 3x and 5 – 4x + 2x2, subtract the sum of 3x2 – 5x and
©
–x2 + 2x + 5.
We know that the value of an algebraic expression depends on the values of the variables
tt
forming the expression. There are a number of situations in which we need to find the value
no
SOLUTION Putting x = 2
(i) In x + 4, we get the value of x + 4, i.e.,
x+4=2+4=6
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 241
(ii) In 4x – 3, we get
4x – 3 = (4 × 2) – 3 = 8 – 3 = 5
(iii) In 19 – 5x2, we get
19 – 5x2 = 19 – (5 × 22) = 19 – (5 × 4) = 19 – 20 = – 1
(iv) In 100 – 10x3, we get
100 – 10x3 = 100 – (10 × 23) = 100 – (10 × 8) (Note 23 = 8)
= 100 – 80 = 20
SOLUTION
d
he
(i) Putting the value of n = – 2, in 5n – 2, we get,
pu T
5(– 2) – 2 = – 10 – 2 = – 12
is
re ER
(ii) In 5n2 + 5n – 2, we have,
bl
be NC
5n2 + 5n – 2 = 20 – 12 = 8
(iii) Now, for n = – 2,
o
5n2 + 5n – 2 = 8 and
tt
Combining,
n3 + 5n2 + 5n – 2 = – 8 + 8 = 0
We shall now consider expressions of two variables, for example, x + y, xy. To work
out the numerical value of an expression of two variables, we need to give the values of
both variables. For example, the value of (x + y), for x = 3 and y = 5, is 3 + 5 = 8.
EXAMPLE 9 Find the value of the following expressions for a = 3, b = 2.
(i) a + b (ii) 7a – 4b (iii) a2 + 2ab + b2
(iv) a3 – b3
2020-21
242 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 12.3
1. If m = 2, find the value of:
(i) m – 2 (ii) 3m – 5 (iii) 9 – 5m
5m
d
(iv) 3m2 – 2m – 7 (v) 4
2
he
2. If p = – 2, find the value of:
pu T
(i) 4p + 7 (ii) – 3p2 + 4p + 7 (iii) – 2p3 – 3p2 + 4p + 7
is
re ER
3. Find the value of the following expressions, when x = –1:
bl
(i) 2x – 7 (ii) – x + 2 (iii) x2 + 2x + 1
be NC
(iv) 2x2 – x – 2
4. If a = 2, b = – 2, find the value of:
©
(iv) a2 + ab + 2
6. Simplify the expressions and find the value if x is equal to 2
no
(i) x + 7 + 4 (x – 5) (ii) 3 (x + 2) + 5x – 7
(iii) 6x + 5 (x – 2) (iv) 4(2x – 1) + 3x + 11
7. Simplify these expressions and find their values if x = 3, a = – 1, b = – 2.
(i) 3x – 5 – x + 9 (ii) 2 – 8x + 4x + 4
(iii) 3a + 5 – 8a + 1 (iv) 10 – 3b – 4 – 5b
(v) 2a – 2b – 4 – 5 + a
8. (i) If z = 10, find the value of z3 – 3(z – 10).
(ii) If p = – 10, find the value of p2 – 2p – 100
9. What should be the value of a if the value of 2x2 + x – a equals to 5, when x = 0?
10. Simplify the expression and find its value when a = 5 and b = – 3.
2(a2 + ab) + 3 – ab
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 243
l Perimeter formulas
1. The perimeter of an equilateral triangle = 3 × the length of its side. If we denote the
length of the side of the equilateral triangle by l, then the perimeter of the equilateral
triangle = 3l
2. Similarly, the perimeter of a square = 4l
where l = the length of the side of the square.
d
3. Perimeter of a regular pentagon = 5l
he
pu T
where l = the length of the side of the pentagon and so on.
is
re ER
l Area formulas
bl
1. If we denote the length of a square by l, then the area of the square = l 2
be NC
2. If we denote the length of a rectangle by l and its breadth by b, then the area of the
rectangle = l × b = lb.
©
3. Similarly, if b stands for the base and h for the height of a triangle, then the area of the
b × h bh
triangle = = .
2 2
o
tt
Once a formula, that is, the algebraic expression for a given quantity is known, the
value of the quantity can be computed as required.
no
For example, for a square of length 3 cm, the perimeter is obtained by putting the value
l = 3 cm in the expression of the perimeter of a square, i.e., 4l.
The perimeter of the given square = (4 × 3) cm = 12 cm.
Similarly, the area of the square is obtained by putting in the value of
l (= 3 cm) in the expression for the area of a square, that is, l 2;
Area of the given square = (3)2 cm2 = 9 cm2.
2020-21
244 MATHEMATICS
DO THIS
Take (small) line segments of equal length such as matchsticks, tooth pricks or
pieces of straws cut into smaller pieces of equal length. Join them in patterns as
shown in the figures given:
1. Observe the pattern in Fig 12.1.
It consists of repetitions of the shape
made from 4 line segments. As you see for
one shape you need 4 segments, for two
d
shapes 7, for three 10 and so on. If n is the
he
number of shapes, then the number of
pu T
segments required to form n shapes is given
is
re ER
by (3n + 1). bl
You may verify this by taking n = 1, 2,
be NC
the figure.
2. Now, consider the pattern in Fig 12.2. Here
the shape is repeated. The number of
o
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 245
TRY THESE
Make similar pattern with basic figures as shown
d
he
(The number of segments required to make the figure is given to the right. Also,
pu T
the expression for the number of segments required to make n shapes is also given).
is
re ER
Go ahead and discover more such patterns.
bl
be NC
DO THIS 1
Make the following pattern of dots. If you take a graph paper or a dot paper, it will 4
©
dots in the figure is given by the expression n × n = n2. For example, take n = 4. The
tt
number of dots for the figure with 4 dots in a row (or a column) is 4 × 4 = 16, as is
16
no
indeed seen from the figure. You may check this for other values of n. The ancient
Greek mathematicians called the number 1, 4, 9, 16, 25, ... square numbers.
l Pattern in geometry
What is the number of diagonals we can draw from one vertex of a quadrilateral?
Check it, it is one. n2
2020-21
246 MATHEMATICS
E D F E
D C
C A D
A
A B
B B C
From one vertex of a hexagon? It is 3.
The number of diagonals we can draw from one vertex of a polygon of n sides is
(n – 3). Check it for a heptagon (7 sides) and octagon (8 sides) by drawing figures.
What is the number for a triangle (3 sides)? Observe that the diagonals drawn from any
one vertex divide the polygon in as many non-overlapping triangles as the number of
d
diagonals that can be drawn from the vertex plus one.
he
pu T
EXERCISE 12.4
is
re ER
bl
1. Observe the patterns of digits made from line segments of equal length. You will find
be NC
2020-21
ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS 247
2. Use the given algebraic expression to complete the table of number patterns.
S. Expression Terms
st nd rd th th
No. 1 2 3 4 5 ... 10th … 100th …
(i) 2n – 1 1 3 5 7 9 - 19 - - -
(ii) 3n + 2 5 8 11 14 - - - - - -
(iii) 4n + 1 5 9 13 17 - - - - - -
(iv) 7n + 20 27 34 41 48 - - - - - -
(v) n2 + 1 2 5 10 17 - - - - 10,001 -
d
he
1. Algebraic expressions are formed from variables and constants. We use the
pu T
operations of addition, subtraction, multiplication and division on the variables
is
re ER
and constants to form expressions. For example, the expression 4xy + 7 is formed
from the variables x and y and constants 4 and 7. The constant 4 and the variables
bl
x and y are multiplied to give the product 4xy and the constant 7 is added to this
be NC
3. A term is a product of factors. The term 4xy in the expression 4xy + 7 is a product
of factors x, y and 4. Factors containing variables are said to be algebraic factors.
o
4. The coefficient is the numerical factor in the term. Sometimes anyone factor in a
tt
5. Any expression with one or more terms is called a polynomial. Specifically a one
term expression is called a monomial; a two-term expression is called a binomial;
and a three-term expression is called a trinomial.
6. Terms which have the same algebraic factors are like terms. Terms which have different
algebraic factors are unlike terms. Thus, terms 4xy and – 3xy are like terms; but
terms 4xy and – 3x are not like terms.
7. The sum (or difference) of two like terms is a like term with coefficient equal to
the sum (or difference) of the coefficients of the two like terms. Thus,
8xy – 3xy = (8 – 3 )xy, i.e., 5xy.
8. When we add two algebraic expressions, the like terms are added as given
above; the unlike terms are left as they are. Thus, the sum of 4x2 + 5x
and 2x + 3 is 4x2 + 7x + 3; the like terms 5x and 2x add to 7x; the unlike
terms 4x2 and 3 are left as they are.
2020-21
248 MATHEMATICS
9. In situations such as solving an equation and using a formula, we have to find the
value of an expression. The value of the expression depends on the value of the
variable from which the expression is formed. Thus, the value of 7x – 3 for x = 5 is
32, since 7(5) – 3 = 35 – 3 = 32.
10. Rules and formulas in mathematics are written in a concise and general form using
algebraic expressions:
Thus, the area of rectangle = lb, where l is the length and b is the breadth of the
rectangle.
The general (nth) term of a number pattern (or a sequence) is an expression in n.
Thus, the nth term of the number pattern 11, 21, 31, 41, . . . is (10n + 1).
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
no
2020-21
EXPONENTS AND POWERS 249
Chapter 13
Exponents and
Powers
d
13.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
Do you know what the mass of earth is? It is
is
re ER
5,970,000,000,000,000,000,000,000 kg! bl
Can you read this number?
be NC
These very large numbers are difficult to read, understand and compare. To make these
numbers easy to read, understand and compare, we use exponents. In this Chapter, we shall
learn about exponents and also learn how to use them.
o
tt
13.2 EXPONENTS
no
2020-21
250 MATHEMATICS
We have used numbers like 10, 100, 1000 etc., while writing numbers in an expanded
form. For example, 47561 = 4 × 10000 + 7 × 1000 + 5 × 100 + 6 × 10 + 1
This can be written as 4 × 104 + 7 ×103 + 5 × 102 + 6 × 10 + 1.
Try writing these numbers in the same way 172, 5642, 6374.
In all the above given examples, we have seen numbers whose base is 10. However
the base can be any other number also. For example:
81 = 3 × 3 × 3 × 3 can be written as 81 = 34, here 3 is the base and 4 is the exponent.
Some powers have special names. For example,
102, which is 10 raised to the power 2, also read as ‘10 squared’ and
103, which is 10 raised to the power 3, also read as ‘10 cubed’.
Can you tell what 53 (5 cubed) means?
53 = 5 × 5 × 5 = 125
d
he
So, we can say 125 is the third power of 5.
pu T
What is the exponent and the base in 53?
is
re ER
Similarly, 25 = 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 = 32, which is the fifth power of 2.
bl
In 25, 2 is the base and 5 is the exponent.
be NC
TRY THESE
Find five more such examples, where a number is expressed in exponential form.
o
You can also extend this way of writing when the base is a negative integer.
What does (–2)3 mean?
It is (–2)3 = (–2) × (–2) × (–2) = – 8
Is (–2)4 = 16? Check it.
Instead of taking a fixed number let us take any integer a as the base, and write the
numbers as,
a × a = a2 (read as ‘a squared’ or ‘a raised to the power 2’)
a × a × a = a3 (read as ‘a cubed’ or ‘a raised to the power 3’)
a × a × a × a = a4 (read as a raised to the power 4 or the 4th power of a)
..............................
a × a × a × a × a × a × a = a7 (read as a raised to the power 7 or the 7th power of a)
and so on.
a × a × a × b × b can be expressed as a3b2 (read as a cubed b squared)
2020-21
EXPONENTS AND POWERS 251
d
28 = 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 = 256
he
Clearly, 28 > 8 2 pu T
is
re ER
EXAMPLE 4 Expand a3 b2, a2 b3, b2 a3, b3 a2. Are they all same?
bl
SOLUTION a3 b2 = a3 × b2
be NC
= (a × a × a) × (b × b)
= a×a×a×b×b
a b = a2 × b3
2 3
©
= a×a×b×b×b
b a = b2 × a3
2 3
= b×b×a×a×a
o
tt
b a = b3 × a2
3 2
= b×b×b×a×a
no
Note that in the case of terms a3 b2 and a2 b3 the powers of a and b are different. Thus
a b and a2 b3 are different.
3 2
On the other hand, a3 b2 and b2 a3 are the same, since the powers of a and b in these
two terms are the same. The order of factors does not matter.
Thus, a3 b2 = a3 × b2 = b2 × a3 = b2 a3. Similarly, a2 b3 and b3 a2 are the same.
EXAMPLE 5 Express the following numbers as a product of powers of prime factors:
(i) 72 (ii) 432 (iii) 1000 (iv) 16000 2 72
SOLUTION 2 36
(i) 72 = 2 × 36 = 2 × 2 × 18 2 18
=2×2×2×9 3 9
= 2 × 2 × 2 × 3 × 3 = 23 × 32
Thus, 72 = 23 × 32 (required prime factor product form) 3
2020-21
252 MATHEMATICS
d
Is Atul’s method correct?
he
pu T
(iv) 16,000 = 16 × 1000 = (2 × 2 × 2 × 2) ×1000 = 24 ×103 (as 16 = 2 × 2 × 2 × 2)
is
re ER
= (2 × 2 × 2 × 2) × (2 × 2 × 2 × 5 × 5 × 5) = 24 × 23 × 53
bl (Since 1000 = 2 × 2 × 2 × 5 × 5 × 5)
be NC
= (2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 ) × (5 × 5 × 5)
or, 16,000 = 27 × 53
EXAMPLE 6 Work out (1)5, (–1)3, (–1)4, (–10)3, (–5)4.
©
SOLUTION
(i) We have (1)5 = 1 × 1 × 1 × 1 × 1 = 1
o
EXERCISE 13.1
1. Find the value of:
(i) 26 (ii) 93 (iii) 112 (iv) 54
2. Express the following in exponential form:
(i) 6 × 6 × 6 × 6 (ii) t × t (iii) b × b × b × b
(iv) 5 × 5× 7 × 7 × 7 (v) 2 × 2 × a × a (vi) a × a × a × c × c × c × c × d
2020-21
EXPONENTS AND POWERS 253
d
7. Simplify:
he
(i) (– 4)3
pu T
(ii) (–3) × (–2)3 (iii) (–3)2 × (–5)2
is
re ER
(iv) (–2)3 × (–10)3 bl
8. Compare the following numbers:
be NC
22 × 23 = (2 × 2) × (2 × 2 × 2)
tt
= 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 = 25 = 22+3
no
Note that the base in 22 and 23 is same and the sum of the exponents, i.e., 2 and 3 is 5
(ii) (–3)4 × (–3)3 = [(–3) × (–3) × (–3)× (–3)] × [(–3) × (–3) × (–3)]
= (–3) × (–3) × (–3) × (–3) × (–3) × (–3) × (–3)
= (–3)7
= (–3)4+3
Again, note that the base is same and the sum of exponents, i.e., 4 and 3, is 7
(iii) a2 × a4 = (a × a) × (a × a × a × a)
= a × a × a × a × a × a = a6
(Note: the base is the same and the sum of the exponents is 2 + 4 = 6)
Similarly, verify:
42 × 42 = 42+2
32 × 33 = 32+3
2020-21
254 MATHEMATICS
Caution!
Consider 23 × 32
d
he
Can you add the exponents? No! Do you see ‘why’? The base of 23 is 2 and base
pu T
of 32 is 3. The bases are not same.
is
re ER
13.3.2 Dividing Powers with the Same Base
bl
Let us simplify 37 ÷ 34?
be NC
37 3×3×3× 3× 3× 3× 3
37 ÷ 34 = 4 =
3 3×3×3×3
©
= 3 × 3 × 3 = 33 = 37 – 4
Thus 37 ÷ 34 = 37 – 4
(Note, in 37 and 34 the base is same and 37 ÷ 34 becomes 37–4)
o
tt
Similarly,
no
56 5 × 5 × 5 × 5 × 5 × 5
5 ÷5 = 2 =
6 2
5 5×5
= 5 × 5 × 5 × 5 = 54 = 56 – 2
or 56 ÷ 52 = 56 – 2
Let a be a non-zero integer, then,
a4 a × a × a × a
a ÷a = 2 = = a × a = a 2 = a4
4 2 2
a a×a
or a4 ÷ a2 = a4 – 2
Now can you answer quickly?
108 ÷ 103 = 108 – 3 = 105
79 ÷ 76 = 7
a8 ÷ a5 = a
2020-21
EXPONENTS AND POWERS 255
( ) ( )
2 4
Simplify 23 ; 32
Now, ( 2 ) means 2
d
3 2 3
is multiplied two times with itself.
he
(2 ) = 2
3 2 3
pu T
× 23
is
re ER
= 23 + 3 (Since am × an = am + n)
bl
= 26 = 23 × 2
be NC
Thus (2 ) = 2
3 2 3×2
(3 ) = 3
2 4
©
2
Similarly × 32 × 32 × 32
= 32 + 2 + 2 + 2
o
2×4
=3
Can you tell what would ( 7 2 ) would be equal to?
no
10
So (2 ) = 2
3 2 3×2
= 26
(3 ) = 3
2 4 2×4
= 38
(7 ) = 7
2 10 2 × 10
= 720
TRY THESE
(a ) = a
2 3 2×3
= a6
Simplify and write the answer in
(a ) = a
m 3 m×3
=a3m exponential form:
From this we can generalise for any non-zero integer ‘a’, where ‘m’ (i) ( 62 )
4
(ii) (2 )
2 100
2020-21
256 MATHEMATICS
52 × 52 × 52 = 56 = 15,625
Therefore (52)3 > (52) × 3
d
he
= (2 × 3) × (2 × 3) × (2 × 3)
pu T =6×6×6
is
re ER
bl = 63 (Observe 6 is the product of bases 2 and 3)
Consider 44 × 34 = (4 × 4 × 4 × 4) × (3 × 3 × 3 × 3)
be NC
= (4 × 3) × (4 × 3) × (4 × 3) × (4 × 3)
= 12 × 12 × 12 × 12
= 124
©
Consider, also, 32 × a2 = (3 × 3) × (a × a)
= (3 × a) × (3 × a)
TRY THESE = (3 × a)2
o
(i) 43 × 23 (ii) 25 × b5
(iii) a2 × t2 (iv) 56 × (–2)6 = (a × b) × (a × b) × (a × b) × (a × b)
= (a × b)4
(v) (–2)4 × (–3)4
= (ab)4 (Note a × b = ab)
In general, for any non-zero integer a
am × bm = (ab)m (where m is any whole number)
EXAMPLE 8 Express the following terms in the exponential form:
(i) (2 × 3)5 (ii) (2a)4 (iii) (– 4m)3
SOLUTION
(i) (2 × 3)5 = (2 × 3) × (2 × 3) × (2 × 3) × (2 × 3) × (2 × 3)
= (2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2) × (3 × 3× 3 × 3 × 3)
= 25 × 35
2020-21
EXPONENTS AND POWERS 257
(ii) (2a)4 = 2a × 2a × 2a × 2a
= (2 × 2 × 2 × 2) × (a × a × a × a)
= 24 × a4
3
(iii) (– 4m) = (– 4 × m)3
= (– 4 × m) × (– 4 × m) × (– 4 × m)
= (– 4) × (– 4) × (– 4) × (m × m × m) = (– 4)3 × (m)3
24 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 2 2 2 2 2
4 TRY THESE
(i) 4 = = × × × = Put into another form
3 3 × 3× 3 × 3 3 3 3 3 3
d
m
a
he
3 m m
a a×a×a a a a a
3 using a ÷ b = :
(ii) = = × × = pu T b
b3 b × b × b b b b b
is
re ER
(i) 45 ÷ 35
From these examples we may generalise
bl (ii) 25 ÷ b5
(iii) (– 2)3 ÷ b3
be NC
m
am a
a ÷ b = m = where a and b are any non-zero integers and
m m
(iv) p4 ÷ q4
b b
(v) 56 ÷ (–2)6
m is a whole number.
©
5
4
−4
EXAMPLE 9 Expand: (i)
3
(ii)
5 7
o
SOLUTION
tt
4
3× 3× 3× 3
no
3 34
(i) = 4 = What is a0?
5 5 5× 5×5× 5 Obeserve the following pattern:
26 = 64
5
−4 ( − 4)5 25 = 32
(ii) = =
7 75 24 = 16
23 = 8
22 = ?
l Numbers with exponent zero
21 = ?
35 20 = ?
Can you tell what 5 equals to? You can guess the value of 20 by just studying the
3
pattern!
35 3× 3× 3× 3× 3 You find that 20 = 1
5 =
=1
3 3× 3× 3× 3× 3
If you start from 36 = 729, and proceed as shown
by using laws of exponents above finding 35, 34, 33,... etc, what will be 30 = ?
2020-21
258 MATHEMATICS
35 ÷ 35 = 35 – 5 = 30
So 30 = 1
Can you tell what 70 is equal to?
73 ÷73 = 73 – 3 = 70
73 7×7×7
And 3 =
=1
7 7×7×7
Therefore 70 = 1
Similarly a3 ÷ a3 = a3–3 = a0
a3 a × a × a
And a3 ÷ a3 = = =1
a3 a × a × a
d
Thus a0 = 1 (for any non-zero integer a)
he
pu T
So, we can say that any number (except 0) raised to the power (or exponent) 0 is 1.
is
re ER
13.4 M ISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES USING THE LAWS OF
bl
EXPONENTS
be NC
SOLUTION We have, 8 × 8 × 8 × 8 = 84
But we know that 8 = 2 × 2 × 2 = 23
o
tt
Therefore 84 = (23)4 = 23 × 23 × 23 × 23
= 23 × 4 [You may also use (am)n = amn]
no
= 2 12
EXAMPLE 11 Simplify and write the answer in the exponential form.
37 5
(i) 32 × 3 (ii) 23 × 22 × 55 (iii) (62 × 64) ÷ 63
(iv) [(22)3 × 36] × 56 (v) 82 ÷ 23
SOLUTION
37 5
(i) 32 × 3 = ( 3 ) × 3
7− 2 5
= 35×35 = 35+5 = 310
2020-21
EXPONENTS AND POWERS 259
(ii) 23 × 22 × 55 = 23+2 × 55
= 25 × 55 = (2 × 5)5 = 105
(iii) (6 2
× 6 4 ) ÷ 63 = 62+ 4 ÷ 63
66 6−3
= 3 =6 =6
3
( 2 × 3)
6
= × 56
( 2 × 3 × 5)
6 6
= 30
d
=
he
(v) 8 = 2 × 2 × 2 = 23 pu T
Therefore 82 ÷ 23 = (23)2 ÷ 23
is
re ER
= 26 ÷ 23 = 26 – 3 = 23
bl
be NC
EXAMPLE 12 Simplify:
124 × 93 × 4 2 × 34 × 25
(i) (ii) 23 × a3 × 5a4 (iii)
63 × 82 × 27 9 × 42
©
SOLUTION
o
(i) We have
tt
=
63 × 82 × 27 (2×3)3×(23 )2 ×33
=
( 2 ) × (3)
2 4 4
× 32 ×3 × 22 28 × 22 × 34 × 36
= 3
23 × 33 × 22×3 × 33 2 × 26 × 33 × 33
2020-21
260 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 13.2
d
he
pu T
1. Using laws of exponents, simplify and write the answer in exponential form:
is
re ER
(i) 32 × 34 × 38 bl (ii) 615 ÷ 610 (iii) a3 × a2
( )
3
(iv) 7x ×72 (v) 52 ÷ 53 (vi) 25 × 55
be NC
(viii) ( 34 ) (2 ÷ 215 ) × 23
3 20
(vii) a4 × b4 (ix)
©
(x) 8t ÷ 82
2. Simplify and express each of the following in exponential form:
o
23 × 34 × 4
(( 5 ) × 5 ) ÷ 5
2 3
tt
(i) (ii) 4 7
(iii) 254 ÷ 53
3 × 32
no
3 × 7 2 × 118 37
(iv) (v) (vi) 20 + 30 + 40
21× 113 34 × 33
28 × a 5
(vii) 20 × 30 × 40 (viii) (30 + 20) × 50 (ix)
43 × a 3
a5 4 5 × a 8b 3
(x) 3 × a (2 × 2)
8 3 2
(xi) (xii)
a 4 5 × a 5b 2
3. Say true or false and justify your answer:
(i) 10 × 1011 = 10011 (ii) 23 > 52 (iii) 23 × 32 = 65
(iv) 30 = (1000)0
2020-21
EXPONENTS AND POWERS 261
4. Express each of the following as a product of prime factors only in exponential form:
(i) 108 × 192 (ii) 270 (iii) 729 × 64
(iv) 768
5. Simplify:
(i)
(2 )
5 2
× 73
(ii)
25 × 52 × t 8
(iii)
35 × 105 × 25
83 × 7 103 × t 4 57 × 65
d
We can express it using powers of 10 in the exponent form:
he
Therefore,
pu T
47561 = 4 × 104 + 7 × 103 + 5 × 102 + 6 × 101 + 1 × 100
is
re ER
(Note 10,000 = 104, 1000 = 103, 100 = 102, 10 = 101 and 1 = 100)
bl
Let us expand another number:
be NC
Notice how the exponents of 10 start from a maximum value of 5 and go on decreasing
by 1 at a step from the left to the right upto 0.
o
Let us now go back to the beginning of the chapter. We said that large numbers can be
no
conveniently expressed using exponents. We have not as yet shown this. We shall do so now.
1. Sun is located 300,000,000,000,000,000,000 m from the centre of our Milky Way
Galaxy.
2. Number of stars in our Galaxy is 100,000,000,000.
3. Mass of the Earth is 5,976,000,000,000,000,000,000,000 kg.
These numbers are not convenient to write and read. To make it convenient TRY THESE
we use powers. Expand by expressing
Observe the following: powers of 10 in the
59 = 5.9 × 10 = 5.9 × 101 exponential form:
(i) 172
590 = 5.9 × 100 = 5.9 × 102
(ii) 5,643
5900 = 5.9 × 1000 = 5.9 × 103 (iii) 56,439
5900 = 5.9 × 10000 = 5.9 × 104 and so on. (iv) 1,76,428
2020-21
262 MATHEMATICS
We have expressed all these numbers in the standard form. Any number can be
expressed as a decimal number between 1.0 and 10.0 including 1.0 multiplied by a power
of 10. Such a form of a number is called its standard form. Thus,
5,985 = 5.985 × 1,000 = 5.985 × 103 is the standard form of 5,985.
Note, 5,985 can also be expressed as 59.85 × 100 or 59.85 × 102. But these are not
the standard forms, of 5,985. Similarly, 5,985 = 0.5985 × 10,000 = 0.5985 × 104 is also
not the standard form of 5,985.
We are now ready to express the large numbers we came across at the beginning of
the chapter in this form.
The, distance of Sun from the centre of our Galaxy i.e.,
300,000,000,000,000,000,000 m can be written as
3.0 × 100,000,000,000,000,000,000 = 3.0 × 1020 m
d
Now, can you express 40,000,000,000 in the similar way?
he
Count the number of zeros in it. It is 10.
pu T
So, 40,000,000,000 = 4.0 × 1010
is
re ER
Mass of the Earth = 5,976,000,000,000,000,000,000,000 kg
bl
= 5.976 × 1024 kg
be NC
Do you agree with the fact, that the number when written in the standard form is much
easier to read, understand and compare than when the number is written with 25 digits?
Now,
©
Simply by comparing the powers of 10 in the above two, you can tell that the mass of
tt
The distance betwen Saturn and Uranus is 1,439,000,000,000 m or 1.439 × 1012 m. The
distance between Sun and Earth is 149, 600,000,000 m or 1.496 × 1011m.
Can you tell which of the three distances is smallest?
EXAMPLE 13 Express the following numbers in the standard form:
(i) 5985.3 (ii) 65,950
(iii) 3,430,000 (iv) 70,040,000,000
SOLUTION
(i) 5985.3 = 5.9853 × 1000 = 5.9853 × 103
(ii) 65,950 = 6.595 × 10,000 = 6.595 × 104
(iii) 3,430,000 = 3.43 × 1,000,000 = 3.43 × 106
(iv) 70,040,000,000 = 7.004 × 10,000,000,000 = 7.004 × 1010
2020-21
EXPONENTS AND POWERS 263
A point to remember is that one less than the digit count (number of digits) to the left
of the decimal point in a given number is the exponent of 10 in the standard form. Thus, in
70,040,000,000 there is no decimal point shown; we assume it to be at the (right) end.
From there, the count of the places (digits) to the left is 11. The exponent of 10 in the
standard form is 11 – 1 = 10. In 5985.3 there are 4 digits to the left of the decimal point
and hence the exponent of 10 in the standard form is 4 – 1 = 3.
EXERCISE 13.3
1. Write the following numbers in the expanded forms:
279404, 3006194, 2806196, 120719, 20068
2. Find the number from each of the following expanded forms:
d
(a) 8 ×104 + 6 ×103 + 0×102 + 4×101 + 5×100
he
(b) 4 ×105 + 5×103 + 3×102 + 2×100
pu T
is
re ER
(c) 3 ×104 + 7×102 + 5×100 bl
(d) 9 ×105 + 2×102 + 3×101
be NC
2020-21
264 MATHEMATICS
d
(a) am × an = am + n
he
(b) am ÷ an = am – n,
pu T m>n
is
(c) (am)n = amn
re ER
(d) am × bm = (ab)m
bl
be NC
m
a
(e) a ÷ b =
m n
b
(f) a0 = 1
©
2020-21
SYMMETRY 265
Chapter 14
Symmetry
d
14.1 INTRODUCTION
he
pu T
Symmetry is an important geometrical concept, commonly exhibited in nature and is used
is
re ER
almost in every field of activity. Artists, professionals, designers of clothing or jewellery, car
bl
manufacturers, architects and many others make use of the idea of symmetry. The beehives,
the flowers, the tree-leaves, religious symbols, rugs, and handkerchiefs — everywhere you
be NC
Nature
no
Architecture Engineering
You have already had a ‘feel’ of line symmetry in your previous class.
A figure has a line symmetry, if there is a line about which the figure may be folded so that
the two parts of the figure will coincide.
You might like to recall these ideas. Here are some activities to help you.
2020-21
266 MATHEMATICS
Enjoy identifying lines (also called axes) of symmetry in the designs you collect.
Let us now strengthen our ideas on symmetry further. Study the following figures in
which the lines of symmetry are marked with dotted lines. [Fig 14.1 (i) to (iv)]
d
14.2 LINES OF SYMMETRY FOR REGULAR POLYGONS
he
pu T
You know that a polygon is a closed figure made of several line segments. The polygon
is
re ER
made up of the least number of line segments is the triangle. (Can there be a polygon that
bl
you can draw with still fewer line segments? Think about it).
be NC
A polygon is said to be regular if all its sides are of equal length and all its angles are of
equal measure. Thus, an equilateral triangle is a regular polygon of three sides. Can you
name the regular polygon of four sides?
An equilateral triangle is regular because each of its sides has same length and each of
©
60°
tt
a a
no
60° 60°
a
Fig 14.2
A square is also regular because all its sides are of equal length and each of its angles
is a right angle (i.e., 90°). Its diagonals are seen to be perpendicular bisectors of one
another (Fig 14.3).
Fig 14.3
2020-21
SYMMETRY 267
If a pentagon is regular, naturally, its sides should have equal length. You will, later on,
learn that the measure of each of its angles is 108° (Fig 14.4).
Fig 14.4
A regular hexagon has all its sides equal and each of its angles measures
120°. You will learn more of these figures later (Fig 14.5). Fig 14.5
d
The regular polygons are symmetrical figures and hence their lines of
he
symmetry are quite interesting, pu T
Each regular polygon has as many lines of symmetry as it has sides [Fig 14.6 (i) - (iv)].
is
re ER
We say, they have multiple lines of symmetry. bl
be NC
©
o
tt
no
Fig 14.6
Perhaps, you might like to investigate this by paper folding. Go ahead!
The concept of line symmetry is closely related to mirror reflection. A shape has line
symmetry when one half of it is the mirror image of the other half (Fig 14.7). A mirror line,
thus, helps to visualise a line of symmetry (Fig 14.8).
Fig 14.7
Is the dotted line a mirror line? No. Is the dotted line a mirror line? Yes.
Fig 14.8
2020-21
268 MATHEMATICS
While dealing with mirror reflection, care is needed to note down the left-right changes
in the orientation, as seen in the figure here (Fig 14.9).
R R
(i) (ii)
Fig 14.9
The shape is same, but the other way round!
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
Fold a sheet into two halves Punch a hole two holes about the
symmetric fold.
©
Fig 14.10
The fold is a line (or axis) of symmetry. Study about punches at different locations on
the folded paper and the corresponding lines of symmetry (Fig 14.10).
o
tt
EXERCISE 14.1
no
1. Copy the figures with punched holes and find the axes of symmetry for the following:
2020-21
SYMMETRY 269
d
he
3. In the following figures, the mirror line (i.e., the line of symmetry) is given as a dotted
pu T
line. Complete each figure performing reflection in the dotted (mirror) line. (You might
is
re ER
perhaps place a mirror along the dotted line and look into the mirror for the image).
bl
Are you able to recall the name of the figure you complete?
be NC
©
4. The following figures have more than one line of symmetry. Such figures are said to
tt
2020-21
270 MATHEMATICS
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
(j) A circle
tt
8. What letters of the English alphabet have reflectional symmetry (i.e., symmetry related
no
2020-21
SYMMETRY 271
What can you say about the rotation of the blades of a ceiling fan? Do they rotate
clockwise or anticlockwise? Or do they rotate both ways?
If you spin the wheel of a bicycle, it rotates. It can rotate in either way: both clockwise
and anticlockwise. Give three examples each for (i) a clockwise rotation and (ii) anticlockwise
rotation.
When an object rotates, its shape and size do not change. The rotation turns an object
about a fixed point. This fixed point is the centre of rotation. What is the centre of
rotation of the hands of a clock? Think about it.
The angle of turning during rotation is called the angle of rotation. A full
turn, you know, means a rotation of 360°. What is the degree measure of
the angle of rotation for (i) a half-turn? (ii) a quarter-turn?
A half-turn means rotation by 180°; a quarter-turn is rotation by 90°.
When it is 12 O’clock, the hands of a clock are together. By 3 O’clock,
the minute hand would have made three complete turns; but the hour hand
d
would have made only a quarter-turn. What can you say about their positions
he
at 6 O’clock?
pu T
Have you ever made a paper windmill? The Paper windmill in the picture
is
re ER
looks symmetrical (Fig 14.11); but you do not find any line of symmetry. No
folding can help you to have coincident halves. However if you rotate it by
bl
90° about the fixed point, the windmill will look exactly the same. We say the Fig 14.11
be NC
A C D B C A B D A C
o
B A D C B
tt
Fig 14.12
In a full turn, there are precisely four positions (on rotation through the angles 90°,
180°, 270° and 360°) when the windmill looks exactly the same. Because of this, we say
it has a rotational symmetry of order 4.
Here is one more example for rotational symmetry.
Consider a square with P as one of its corners (Fig 14.13).
Let us perform quarter-turns about the centre of the square marked .
P P P
90° 90°
90° 90°
P P
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v)
Fig 14.13
2020-21
272 MATHEMATICS
Fig 14.13 (i) is the initial position. Rotation by 90° about the centre leads
to Fig 14.13 (ii). Note the position of P now. Rotate again through 90° and you get
Fig 14.13 (iii). In this way, when you complete four quarter-turns, the square reaches its
original position. It now looks the same as Fig14.13 (i). This can be seen with the help of
the positions taken by P.
Thus a square has a rotational symmetry of order 4 about its centre. Observe that
in this case,
(i) The centre of rotation is the centre of the square.
(ii) The angle of rotation is 90°.
(iii) The direction of rotation is clockwise.
(iv) The order of rotational symmetry is 4.
TRY THESE
d
he
1. (a) Can you now tell the order of the rotational symmetry for an equilateral triangle?
pu T
(Fig 14.14)
is
re ER
R bl R
be NC
0°
120
12
°
120°
©
2. Which of the following shapes (Fig 14.15) have rotational symmetry about the marked
no
point.
DO THIS
Draw two identical parallelograms, one-ABCD on a piece of paper and the other
A' B' C' D' on a transparent sheet. Mark the points of intersection of their diagonals,
O and O' respectively (Fig 14.16).
Place the parallelograms such that A' lies on A, B' lies on B and so on. O' then falls
on O.
2020-21
SYMMETRY 273
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
For example, when you slice certain fruits, the cross-sections are shapes with rotational
symmetry. This might surprise you when you notice them [Fig 14.17(i)].
Then there are many road signs that exhibit rotational symmetry. Next time when you
o
walk along a busy road, try to identify such road signs and find about the order of rotational
tt
Think of some more examples for rotational symmetry. Discuss in each case:
(i) the centre of rotation (ii) the angle of rotation
(iii) the direction in which the rotation is affected and
(iv) the order of the rotational symmetry.
TRY THESE
Give the order of the rotational symmetry of the given figures about the point
marked (Fig 14.17).
2020-21
274 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE14.2
1. Which of the following figures have rotational symmetry of order more than 1:
d
he
(a) pu T (b) (c) (d)
is
re ER
bl
be NC
You have been observing many shapes and their symmetries so far. By now you
tt
would have understood that some shapes have only line symmetry, some have only
no
rotational symmetry and some have both line symmetry and rotational symmetry.
For example, consider the square shape (Fig 14.19).
How many lines of symmetry does it have?
Does it have any rotational symmetry?
If ‘yes’, what is the order of the rotational symmetry?
Fig 14.19
Think about it.
The circle is the most perfect symmetrical figure, because it can be rotated around
its centre through any angle and at the same time it has unlimited number of lines
of symmetry. Observe any circle pattern. Every line
through the centre (that is every diameter) forms a
line of (reflectional) symmetry and it has rotational
symmetry around the centre for every angle.
2020-21
SYMMETRY 275
DO THIS
Some of the English alphabets have fascinating symmetrical structures.Which capital
letters have just one line of symmetry (like E)? Which capital letters have a rotational
symmetry of order 2 (like I)?
By attempting to think on such lines, you will be able to fill in the following table:
Alphabet Line Number of Lines of Rotational Order of Rotational
Letters Symmetry Symmetry Symmetry Symmetry
Z No 0 Yes 2
S
H Yes Yes
O Yes Yes
d
E Yes
he
N pu T Yes
C
is
re ER
bl
EXERCISE 14.3
be NC
1. Name any two figures that have both line symmetry and rotational symmetry.
2. Draw, wherever possible, a rough sketch of
(i) a triangle with both line and rotational symmetries of order more than 1.
©
(ii) a triangle with only line symmetry and no rotational symmetry of order more
than 1.
(iii) a quadrilateral with a rotational symmetry of order more than 1 but not a line
o
symmetry.
tt
(iv) a quadrilateral with line symmetry but not a rotational symmetry of order more than 1.
3. If a figure has two or more lines of symmetry, should it have rotational symmetry of
no
2020-21
276 MATHEMATICS
5. Name the quadrilaterals which have both line and rotational symmetry of order more
than 1.
6. After rotating by 60° about a centre, a figure looks exactly the same as its original
position. At what other angles will this happen for the figure?
7. Can we have a rotational symmetry of order more than 1 whose angle of rotation is
(i) 45°? (ii) 17°?
d
than one) lines of symmetry.
he
3. Each regular polygon has as many lines of symmetry as it has sides.
Regular
pu T Regular Regular Square Equilateral
is
re ER
Polygon bl hexagon pentagon triangle
Number of lines 6 5 4 3
be NC
of symmetry
4. Mirror reflection leads to symmetry, under which the left-right orientation have to be
taken care of.
©
6. If, after a rotation, an object looks exactly the same, we say that it has a rotational
symmetry.
7. In a complete turn (of 360o), the number of times an object looks exactly the same is
called the order of rotational symmetry. The order of symmetry of a square, for
example, is 4 while, for an equilateral triangle, it is 3.
8. Some shapes have only one line of symmetry, like the letter E; some have only rotational
symmetry, like the letter S; and some have both symmetries like the letter H.
The study of symmetry is important because of its frequent use in day-to-day life and
more because of the beautiful designs it can provide us.
2020-21
VISUALISING SOLID SHAPES 277
Chapter 15
Visualising Solid
Shapes
d
15.1 INTRODUCTION: PLANE FIGURES AND SOLID SHAPES
he
pu T
In this chapter, you will classify figures you have seen in terms of what is known as dimension.
is
re ER
In our day to day life, we see several objects like books, balls, ice-cream cones etc.,
bl
around us which have different shapes. One thing common about most of these objects is that
be NC
Do you remember some of the three dimensional shapes (i.e., solid shapes) we have seen
in earlier classes?
TRY THESE
o
tt
Fig 15.1
2020-21
278 MATHEMATICS
d
he
(iii) pu T (c) Square
is
re ER
bl
be NC
Fig 15.2
o
tt
Note: We can write 2-D in short for 2-dimension and 3-D in short for
3-dimension.
no
2020-21
VISUALISING SOLID SHAPES 279
DO THIS
Complete the following table:
Table 15.1
Vertex
Face
Face Vertex
Edge Edge
Faces (F) 6 4
Edges (E) 12
d
Vertices (V) 8 4
he
pu T
Can you see that, the two dimensional figures can be identified as the faces of the
is
re ER
three dimensional shapes? For example a cylinder
bl has two faces which are circles,
be NC
In order to do this, we would like to get familiar with three dimensional objects closely.
Let us try forming these objects by making what are called nets.
o
Take a cardboard box. Cut the edges to lay the box flat. You have now a net for that box.
no
A net is a sort of skeleton-outline in 2-D [Fig154 (i)], which, when folded [Fig154 (ii)],
results in a 3-D shape [Fig154 (iii)].
2020-21
280 MATHEMATICS
d
given (Fig 15.7) and try to make the 3-D shapes
he
indicated. (You may also like to prepare
pu T
skeleton models using strips of cardboard
is
re ER
fastened with paper clips).
bl Fig 15.6
be NC
©
o
Fig 15.7
We could also try to make a net for making a pyramid like the Great Pyramid in Giza
(Egypt) (Fig 15.8). That pyramid has a square base and triangles on the four sides.
2020-21
VISUALISING SOLID SHAPES 281
TRY THESE
Here you find four nets (Fig 15.10). There are two correct nets among them to make
a tetrahedron. See if you can work out which nets will make a tetrahedron.
Fig 15.10
EXERCISE 15.1
d
he
pu T
1. Identify the nets which can be used to make cubes (cut out copies of the nets and try it):
is
re ER
bl
be NC
2. Dice are cubes with dots on each face. Opposite faces of a die always have a total
of seven dots on them.
Here are two nets to make dice (cubes); the numbers inserted in each square indicate
the number of dots in that box.
Insert suitable numbers in the blanks, remembering that the number on the
opposite faces should total to 7. 1 2
3. Can this be a net for a die? 3 4
Explain your answer. 5 6
2020-21
282 MATHEMATICS
4. Here is an incomplete net for making a cube. Complete it in at least two different
ways. Remember that a cube has six faces. How many are there in the net here?
(Give two separate diagrams. If you like, you may use a squared sheet for easy
manipulation.)
(a) (i)
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
(b) bl (ii)
be NC
(c) (iii)
©
o
tt
(d) (iv)
no
2020-21
VISUALISING SOLID SHAPES 283
are not equal, as they should be in a cube. Still, you are able to recognise it as a cube. Such
a sketch of a solid is called an oblique sketch.
How can you draw such sketches? Let us attempt to learn the technique.
You need a squared (lines or dots) paper. Initially practising to draw on these sheets will
later make it easy to sketch them on a plain sheet (without the aid of squared lines or dots!)
Let us attempt to draw an oblique sketch of a 3 × 3 × 3 (each edge is 3 units) cube (Fig 15.12).
d
he
Step 1
pu T Step 2
is
re ER
Draw the front face. bl Draw the opposite face. Sizes of the
faces have to be same, but the sketch
be NC
Step 3 Step 4
Join the corresponding corners Redraw using dotted lines for
hidden edges. (It is a convention)
The sketch is ready now.
Fig 15.12
In the oblique sketch above, did you note the following?
(i) The sizes of the front faces and its opposite are same; and
(ii) The edges, which are all equal in a cube, appear so in the sketch, though the actual
measures of edges are not taken so.
You could now try to make an oblique sketch of a cuboid (remember the faces in this
case are rectangles)
Note: You can draw sketches in which measurements also agree with those of a given
solid. To do this we need what is known as an isometric sheet. Let us try to
2020-21
284 MATHEMATICS
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
Step 1 Step 2
Draw a rectangle to show the Draw four parallel line segments of
front face. length 3 starting from the four corners
©
of the rectangle.
o
tt
no
Step 3 Step 4
Connect the matching corners This is an isometric sketch
with appropriate line segments. of the cuboid.
Fig 15.13
Note that the measurements are of exact size in an isometric
sketch; this is not so in the case of an oblique sketch.
EXAMPLE 1 Here is an oblique sketch of a cuboid [Fig 15.14(i)].
Draw an isometric sketch that matches this
drawing.
SOLUTION Here is the solution [Fig 15.14(ii)]. Note how the
Fig 15.14 (i) measurements are taken care of. Fig 15.14 (ii)
2020-21
VISUALISING SOLID SHAPES 285
How many units have you taken along (i) ‘length’? (ii) ‘breadth’? (iii) ‘height’? Do
they match with the units mentioned in the oblique sketch?
EXERCISE 15.2
1. Use isometric dot paper and make an isometric sketch for each one of the
given shapes:
d
he
(i)
pu T (ii)
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
(iii)
no
2020-21
286 MATHEMATICS
5. Give (i) an oblique sketch and (ii) an isometric sketch for each of the following:
(a) A cuboid of dimensions 5 cm, 3 cm and 2 cm. (Is your sketch unique?)
(b) A cube with an edge 4 cm long.
An isometric sheet is attached at the end of the book. You could try to make on it some
cubes or cuboids of dimensions specified by your friend.
DO THIS
How
many
cubes?
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
Sometimes when you look at combined shapes, some of them may be hidden from
your view.
be NC
Here are some activities you could try in your free time to help you visualise some solid
objects and how they look. Take some cubes and arrange them as shown in
©
Fig 15.16.
o
tt
no
TRY THESE
Try to guess the number of cubes in the following arrangements (Fig 15.17).
2020-21
VISUALISING SOLID SHAPES 287
Such visualisation is very helpful. Suppose you form a cuboid by joining such cubes.
You will be able to guess what the length, breadth and height of the cuboid would be.
TRY THESE
d
1. Two dice are placed side by side as shown: Can you say what the total
he
would be on the face opposite to
(a) 5 + 6 (b) 4 + 3
pu T
is
re ER
(Remember that in a die sum of numbers on opposite faces is 7)
bl Fig 15.19
2. Three cubes each with 2 cm edge are placed side by side to form a cuboid. Try to
be NC
make an oblique sketch and say what could be its length, breadth and height.
Now let us see how an object which is in 3-D can be viewed in different ways.
15.5.1 One Way to View an Object is by Cutting or Slicing
o
tt
Slicing game
no
Here is a loaf of bread (Fig 15.20). It is like a cuboid with a square face. You ‘slice’ it with
a knife.
When you give a ‘vertical’ cut, you get several pieces, as shown in the
Figure 15.20. Each face of the piece is a square! We call this face a
‘cross-section’ of the whole bread. The cross section is nearly a square
in this case.
Beware! If your cut is not ‘vertical’ you may get a different cross
section! Think about it. The boundary of the cross-section you obtain is a Fig 15.20
plane curve. Do you notice it?
A kitchen play
Have you noticed cross-sections of some vegetables when they are cut for the purposes
of cooking in the kitchen? Observe the various slices and get aware of the shapes that
result as cross-sections.
2020-21
288 MATHEMATICS
Play this
Make clay (or plasticine) models of the following solids and make vertical or horizontal cuts.
Draw rough sketches of the cross-sections you obtain. Name them wherever you can.
Fig 15.21
EXERCISE 15.3
1. What cross-sections do you get when you give a
d
(i) vertical cut (ii) horizontal cut
he
to the following solids?
pu T
is
re ER
(a) A brick (b) A round apple (c) A die
(d) A circular pipe
bl (e) An ice cream cone
be NC
Shadows are a good way to illustrate how three-dimensional objects can be viewed in two
dimensions. Have you seen a shadow play? It is a form of entertainment using solid
Fig 15.22
articulated figures in front of an illuminated back-drop to create the illusion of moving
o
You will need a source of light and a few solid shapes for this activity. (If
no
you have an overhead projector, place the solid under the lamp and do these
investigations.)
Fig 15.23 Keep a torchlight, right in front of a Cone. What type of
shadow does it cast on the screen? (Fig 15.23)
The solid is three-dimensional; what is the dimension of the shadow?
If, instead of a cone, you place a cube in the above game, what type of
shadow will you get?
Experiment with different positions of the source of light and with different
positions of the solid object. Study their effects on the shapes and sizes of the
shadows you get.
Here is another funny experiment that you might have tried already:
Place a circular plate in the open when the Sun at the noon time is just right
above it as shown in Fig 15.24 (i). What is the shadow that you obtain? (i)
2020-21
VISUALISING SOLID SHAPES 289
(ii) (iii)
Fig 15.24 (i) - (iii)
Study the shadows in relation to the position of the Sun and the time of observation.
d
he
EXERCISE 15.4
pu T
is
re ER
1. A bulb is kept burning just right above the following solids. Name the shape of the
bl
shadows obtained in each case. Attempt to give a rough sketch of the shadow.
(You may try to experiment first and then answer these questions).
be NC
©
o
tt
no
2020-21
290 MATHEMATICS
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
Front view Side view Top view
be NC
Fig 15.25
Here is an example of how one gets different views of a given building. (Fig 15.26)
©
o
tt
no
Fig 15.27
Try putting cubes together and then making such sketches from different sides.
2020-21
VISUALISING SOLID SHAPES 291
TRY THESE
1. For each solid, the three views (1), (2), (3) are given. Identify for each solid the
corresponding top, front and side views.
Solid Its views
(1) (2) (3)
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
o
tt
no
2. Draw a view of each solid as seen from the direction indicated by the arrow.
2020-21
292 MATHEMATICS
d
6. Two types of sketches of a solid are possible:
he
pu T
(a) An oblique sketch does not have proportional lengths. Still it conveys all important
is
re ER
aspects of the appearance of the solid.
bl
(b) An isometric sketch is drawn on an isometric dot paper, a sample of which is
given at the end of this book. In an isometric sketch of the solid the measurements
be NC
kept proportional.
7. Visualising solid shapes is a very useful skill. You should be able to see ‘hidden’
parts of the solid shape.
©
side-view and the top-view can provide a lot of information about the shape
observed.
2020-21
ANSWERS 293
A NSWERS
EXERCISE 1.1
1. (a) Lahulspiti: –8°C, Srinagar: –2°C, Shimla: 5°C, Ooty: 14°C, Bangalore: 22°C
(b) 30°C (c) 6°C (d) Yes; No 2. 35
3. –7°C; –3°C 4. 6200 m 5. By a positive integer; Rs 358
6. By a negative integer; – 10. 7. (ii) is the magic square
9. (a) < (b) < (c) > (d) s<
d
(e) >
he
10. (i) 11 jumps (ii) 5 jumps (iii) (a) –3 + 2 –3 + 2 – 3 + 2 – 3 + 2 –3 + 2 –3 = – 8
(b) 4 – 2 + 4 – 2 + 4 = 8
pu T
is
re ER
8 in (b) represents going up 8 steps.bl
EXERCISE 1.2
be NC
(v) –3
EXERCISE 1.3
1. (a) –3 (b) –225 (c) 630 (d) 316 (e) 0
(f) 1320 (g) 162 (h) –360 (i) –24 (j) 36
3. (i) – a (ii) (a) 22 (b) –37 (c) 0
4. –1 × 5 = –5, –1 × 4 = – 4 = – 5 + 1, – 1 × 3 = – 3 = – 4 + 1,
–1 × 2 = – 2 = – 3 + 1, – 1 × 1 = – 1 = – 2 + 1, – 1 × 0 = 0 = – 1 + 1 so, – 1 × (–1) = 0 + 1 = 1.
5. (a) 480 (b) – 53000 (c) – 15000 (d) – 4182
(e) – 62500 (f) 336 (g) 493 (h) 1140
6. – 10°C 7. (i) 8 (ii) 15 (iii) 0
8. (a) Loss of Rs 1000 (b) 4000 bags
9. (a) – 9 (b) – 7 (c) 7 (d) – 11
2020-21
294 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 1.4
1. (a) –3 (b) –10 (c) 4 (d) –1
(e) –13 (f ) 0 (g) 1 (h) –1 (i) 1
3. (a) 1 (b) 75 (c) – 206 (d) –1
(e) – 87 (f ) – 48 (g) –10 (h) –12
4. (–6, 2), (–12, 4), (12, – 4), (9, –3), (–9, 3) (There could be many such pairs)
5. 9 p.m.; – 14°C 6. (i) 8 (ii) 13 7. 1 hour
EXERCISE 2.1
7 39 7 31 91
1. (i)
5
(ii) = 4 (iii)
35
(iv)
165
8 8
d
37 1
he
13 3 39 7
(v) = 2 (vi) =6 pu T (vii) = 4
5 5 6 6 8 8
is
re ER
2 8 2 7 3 1 bl 139 1
2. (i) , , (ii) , , 3. Yes 4. = 46 cm
3 21 9 10 7 5 3 3
be NC
17 5
5. (i) 8 cm (ii) 7 cm ; Perimeter of ∆ABE is greater.
20 6
©
3 2 1 1
6. cm 7. ; Ritu; 8. Vaibhav; by of an hour.
10 5 5 6
o
EXERCISE 2.2
tt
2 1
(vi) 15 (vii) 6 (viii) 16 (ix) 4 (x) 9
7 3
2020-21
ANSWERS 295
3 3 3 1
6. (a) 15 (b) 33 (c) 15 (d) 25
5 4 4 3
1 1
(e) 19 (f) 27
2 5
3 1 19 1 3
7. (a) (i) 1 (ii) 2 (b) (i) 2 (ii) 6 8. (i) 2 litres (ii)
8 9 48 24 5
EXERCISE 2.3
1 3 1 2 6 3
1. (i) (a) (b) (c) (ii) (a) (b) (c)
16 20 3 63 35 70
7 2 9 2
d
2. (i) 1 (ii) (iii) (iv) 1
9 9 16 25
he
(v)
5
(vi) 1
13
pu T (vii) 1
13
is
re ER
8 20 bl 35
1 44 1 33 4 1
3. (i) 2 (ii) 4 (iii) 8 (iv) 2 (v) 1 (vi) 7 (vii) 2
be NC
10 45 42 35 5 7
3 5 1 6 1 1
4. (i) of (ii) of 5. 2 m 6. 10 hours 7. 44 km
5 8 2 7 4 2
©
5 1 8 8
8. (a) (i) (ii) (b) (i) (ii)
10 2 15 15
o
EXERCISE 2.4
tt
no
84 24 3 9 7
1. (i) 16 (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi)
5 7 2 7 5
7 8 7
2. (i) (improper fraction) (ii) (improper fraction) (iii) (proper fraction)
3 5 9
5 7
(iv) (proper fraction) (v) (proper fraction) (vi) 8(whole number)
6 12
(vii) 11 (whole number)
7 4 6 13 7 31
3. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi)
6 45 91 9 8 49
4 2 3 35 21 4
4. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi)
5 3 8 9 16 15
48 11
(vii) (viii)
25 6
2020-21
296 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 2.5
1. (i) 0.5 (ii) 0.7 (iii) 7 (iv) 1.49 (v) 2.30 (vi) 0.88
2. (i) ` 0.07 (ii) ` 7.07 (iii) ` 77.77 (iv) ` 0.50 (v) ` 2.35
3. (i) 0.05m, 0.00005 km (ii) 3.5 cm, 0.035m, 0.000035 km
4. (i) 0.2 kg (ii) 3.470 kg (iii) 4.008 kg
1 1 1 1
5. (i) 2 × 10 + 0 × 1 + 0 × +3× (ii) 2 × 1 + 0 × +3×
10 100 10 100
1 1
(iii) 2 × 100 + 0 × 10 + 0 × 1 + 0 × +3×
10 100
1 1 1
(iv) 2 × 1 + 0 × +3× +4×
10 100 1000
d
6. (i) Ones (ii) Tens (iii) Tenths (iv) Hundredths (v) Thousandths
he
7. Ayub travelled more by 0.9 km or 900 m 8. Sarala bought more fruits
pu T 9. 14.6 km
is
re ER
blEXERCISE 2.6
1. (i) 1.2 (ii) 36.8 (iii) 13.55 (iv) 80.4 (v) 0.35 (vi) 844.08
be NC
(vii) 1.72
2. 17.1 cm2
3. (i) 13 (ii) 368 (iii) 1537 (iv) 1680.7 (v) 3110 (vi) 15610
©
EXERCISE 2.7
no
1. (i) 0.2 (ii) 0.07 (iii) 0.62 (iv) 10.9 (v) 162.8 (vi) 2.07
(vii) 0.99 (viii) 0.16
2. (i) 0.48 (ii) 5.25 (iii) 0.07 (iv) 3.31 (v) 27.223 (vi) 0.056
(vii) 0.397
3. (i) 0.027 (ii) 0.003 (iii) 0.0078 (iv) 4.326 (v) 0.236 (vi) 0.9853
4. (i) 0.0079 (ii) 0.0263 (iii) 0.03853 (iv) 0.1289 (v) 0.0005
5. (i) 2 (ii) 180 (iii) 6.5 (iv) 44.2 (v) 2 (vi) 31
(vii) 510 (viii) 27 (ix) 2.1 6. 18 km
EXERCISE 3.1
2. Marks Tally Marks Frequency
1 | 1
2 || 2
2020-21
ANSWERS 297
3 | 1
4 ||| 3
5 |||| 5
6 |||| 4
7 || 2
8 | 1
9 | 1
d
0+8+ 6+ 4 18 9
3. 2 4. 50 5. (i) 12.5 (ii) 3 (iii) = or (iv) A
he
4 4 2
6. (i) Highest marks = 95, Lowest marks = 39
pu T
(ii) 56 (iii) 73 7. 2058
is
re ER
8. (i) 20.5 (ii) 5.9 (iii) 5 9. (i) 151 cm (ii) 128 cm (iii) 23 cm (iv) 141.4 cm (v) 5
bl
EXERCISE 3.2
be NC
1. Mode = 20, Median = 20, Yes. 2. Mean = 39, Mode = 15, Median = 15, No.
3. (i) Mode = 38, 43; Median = 40 (ii) Yes, there are 2 modes.
4. Mode = 14, Median = 14
©
EXERCISE 3.3
o
EXERCISE 4.1
1. (i) No. (ii) No (iii) Yes (iv) No (v) Yes (vi) No
(vii) Yes (viii) No (ix) No (x) No (xi) Yes
2020-21
298 MATHEMATICS
b
4. (i) x+4=9 (ii) y – 2 = 8 (iii) 10a = 70 (iv) =6
5
3t x
(v) = 15 (vi) 7m + 7 = 77 (vii) – 4 = 4 (viii) 6y – 6 = 60
4 4
z
(ix) + 3 = 30
3
5. (i) The sum of p and 4 is 15 (ii) 7 subtracted from m is 3
(iii) Twice a number m is 7 (iv) One-fifth of a number m is 3
(v) Three-fifth of a number m is 6 (vi) Three times a number p when added to 4 gives 25
d
(vii) 2 subtracted from four times a number p is 18
he
(viii)
pu T
Add 2 to half of a number p to get 8
is
re ER
6. (i) 5m + 7 = 37 (ii) 3y + 4 = 49 bl (iii) 2l + 7 = 87 (iv) 4b = 180°
EXERCISE 4.2
be NC
25
(c) Multiply both sides by 7; p = 28 (d) Divide both sides by 4; x =
no
36 15
(e) Divide both sides by 8; y = (f) Multiply both sides by 3; z =
8 4
7 1
(g) Multiply both sides by 5; a = (h) Divide both sides by 20; t =
3 2
3. (a) Step 1: Add 2 to both sides (b) Step 1: Subtract 7 from both sides
Step 2: Divide both sides by 3; n = 16 Step 2: Divide both sides by 5; m = 2
(c) Step 1: Multiply both sides by 3 (d) Step 1: Multiply both sides 10
Step 2: Divide both sides by 20; p = 6 Step 2: Divide both sides by 3; p = 20
4. (a) p = 10 (b) p = 9 (c) p = 20 (d) p = –15 (e) p = 8 (f) s = –3
(g) s = – 4 (h) s = 0 (i) q = 3 (j) q = 3 (k) q = –3 (l) q = 3
2020-21
ANSWERS 299
EXERCISE 4.3
−18 5
1. (a) y = 8 (b) t = (c) a = –5 (d) q = – 8 (e) x = – 4 (f) x =
5 2
1 4
(g) m = (h) z = –2 (i) l = (j) b = 12
2 9
2. (a) x = 2 (b) n = 12 (c) n = –2 (d) x = – 4 (e) x = 0
12 6
3. (a) p = (b) p = (c) t = 2 (d) p = 7 (e) m = 2
5 5
x 2
4. (a) Possible equations are: 10x + 2 = 22; = ; 5x – 3 = 7
d
5 5
he
(b) Possible equations are: 3x = – 6; 3x + 7 = 1; 3x + 10 = 4
pu T
is
re ER
EXERCISE 4.4
bl
be NC
x 3
1. (a) 8x + 4 = 60; x = 7 (b) – 4 = 3; x = 35 (c) y + 3 = 21; y = 24
5 4
x +19
©
5n
(g) –7 = 23; n = 12
o
2
tt
2. (a) Lowest score = 40 (b) 70° each (c) Sachin: 132 runs, Rahul: 66 runs
no
EXERCISE 5.1
1. (i) 70° (ii) 27° (iii) 33°
2. (i) 75° (ii) 93° (iii) 26°
3. (i) supplementary (ii) complementary (iii) supplementary
(iv) supplementary (v) complementary (vi) complementary
4. 45° 5. 90° 6. ∠2 will increase with the same measure as the decrease in ∠1.
7. (i) No (ii) No (iii) Yes 8. Less than 45°
9. (i) Yes (ii) No (iii) Yes (iv) Yes (v) Yes (vi) ∠COB
10. (i) ∠1, ∠4; ∠5, ∠2 + ∠3 (ii) ∠1, ∠5; ∠4, ∠5
11. ∠1 and ∠2 are not adjacent angles because their vertex is not common.
12. (i) x = 55°, y = 125°, z = 125° (ii) x = 115°, y = 140°, z = 40°
13. (i) 90° (ii) 180° (iii) supplementary (iv) linear pair (v) equal
(vi) obtuse angles
2020-21
300 MATHEMATICS
14. (i) ∠AOD, ∠BOC (ii) ∠EOA, ∠AOB (iii) ∠EOB, ∠EOD
(iv) ∠EOA, ∠EOC (v) ∠AOB, ∠AOE; ∠AOE, ∠EOD; ∠EOD, ∠COD
EXERCISE 5.2
1. (i) Corresponding angle property (ii) Alternate interior angle property
(iii) Interior angles on the same side of the transversal are supplementary
2. (i) ∠1, ∠5; ∠2, ∠6; ∠3, ∠7; ∠4, ∠8 (ii) ∠2, ∠8; ∠3, ∠5
(iii) ∠2, ∠5; ∠3, ∠8 (iv) ∠1, ∠3; ∠2, ∠4; ∠5, ∠7; ∠6, ∠8
3. a = 55°; b = 125°; c = 55°; d = 125°; e = 55°; f = 55°
4. (i) x = 70° (ii) x = 100°
5. (i) ∠DGC = 70° (ii) ∠DEF = 70°
6. (i) l is not parallel to m (ii) l is not parallel to m
(iii) l is parallel to m (iv) l is not parallel to m
d
he
EXERCISE 6.1
pu T
is
re ER
1. Altitude, Median, No.
bl
EXERCISE 6.2
be NC
1. (i) 120° (ii) 110° (iii) 70° (iv) 120° (v) 100° (vi) 90°
2. (i) 65° (ii) 30° (iii) 35° (iv) 60° (v) 50° (vi) 40°
©
EXERCISE 6.3
1. (i) 70° (ii) 60° (iii) 40° (iv) 65° (v) 60° (vi) 30°
2. (i) x = 70°, y = 60° (ii) x = 50°, y = 80° (iii) x = 110°, y = 70°
o
EXERCISE 6.4
1. (i) Not possible (ii) Possible (iii) Not possible
2. (i) Yes (ii) Yes (iii) Yes 3. Yes 4. Yes 5. No
6. Between 3 and 27
EXERCISE 6.5
1. 26 cm 2. 24 cm 3. 9 m 4. (i) and (iii) 5. 18m 6. (ii)
7. 98 cm 8. 68 cm
EXERCISE 7.1
1. (a) they have the same length (b) 70° (c) m∠A = m∠ B
3. ∠A ↔ ∠F, ∠B ↔ ∠E, ∠C ↔ ∠D, AB ↔ FE, BC ↔ ED, AC ↔ FD
4. (i) ∠C (ii) CA (iii) ∠A (iv) BA
2020-21
ANSWERS 301
EXERCISE 7.2
1. (a) SSS Congruence criterion (b) SAS Congruence criterion
(c) ASA Congruence criterion (d) RHS Congruence criterion
2. (a) (i) PE (ii) EN (iii) PN (b) (i) EN (ii) AT
(c) (i) ∠RAT = ∠EPN (ii)∠ATR = ∠PNE
3. (i) Given (ii) Given (iii) Common (iv) SAS Congruence criterion 4. No
5. ∆WON 6. ∆BTA, ∆TPQ 9. BC = QR, ASA Congruence criterion
EXERCISE 8.1
1. (a) 10:1 (b) 500:7 (c) 100:3 (d) 20:1 2. 12 computers
3. (i) Rajasthan : 190 people ; UP : 830 people (ii) Rajasthan
d
he
EXERCISE 8.2
pu T
is
re ER
4
1. (a) 12.5% (b) 125% (c) 7.5% (d) 28 %
7
bl
be NC
1 3 3
3. (i) , 25% (ii) ; 60% (iii) ;37.5%
4 5 8
©
3
4. (a) 37.5 (b) minute or 36 seconds (c) ` 500
5
o
5. (a) 12000 (b) ` 9,000 (c) 1250 km (d) 20 minutes (e) 500 litres
no
1 3 1 1
6. (a) 0.25; (b) 1.5; (c) 0.2; (d) 0.05; 7. 30%
4 2 5 20
8. 40%; 6000 9. ` 40,000 10. 5 matches
EXERCISE 8.3
1. (a) Profit = ` 75; Profit % = 30 (b) Profit = ` 1500; Profit % = 12.5
(c) Profit = ` 500; Profit % = 20 (d) Loss = ` 100; Loss % = 40
2. (a) 75%; 25% (b) 20%, 30%, 50% (c) 20%; 80% (d) 12.5%; 25%; 62.5%
5
3. 2% 4. 5 % 5. ` 12,000 6. ` 16,875
7
7. (i) 12% (ii) 25 g 8. ` 233.75 9. (a) ` 1,632 (b) ` 8,625
10. 0.25% 11. ` 500
2020-21
302 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 9.1
−2 −1 −2 −1 −2 −3 −5 −8 −10 −9
1. (i) , , , , (ii) , , , ,
3 2 5 3 7 2 3 5 7 5
−35 −7 −34 −33 −11 −32 −31 −1 −1 1 1
(iii) = , , = , , (iv) , ,0, ,
45 9 45 45 15 45 45 3 4 3 2
−15 −18 −21 −24 −4 −5 −6 −7
2. (i) , , , (ii) , , ,
25 30 35 40 16 20 24 28
5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14
(iii) , , , (iv) , , ,
−30 −36 −42 −48 −12 −15 −18 −21
−4 −6 −8 −10 10 15 20 25 8 12 16 28
3. (i) , , , (ii) , , , (iii) , , ,
d
14 21 28 35 −6 −9 −12 −15 18 27 36 63
he
3
pu T 4
is
re ER
4. (i)
–2 –1 0 bl 1 2
be NC
(ii)
–1 –5 0 1
8
–7
©
4
(iii)
–2 –1 0 1 2
o
tt
7
8
no
(iv)
–1 0 1
7 8 −4 −5
5. P represents Q represents R represents S represents
3 3 3 3
6. (ii), (iii), (iv), (v)
−4 5 −11 −4
7. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
3 9 18 5
8. (i) < (ii) < (iii) = (iv) > (v) < (vi) = (vii) >
5 −5 2 1 2
9. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) −3
2 6 −3 4 7
−3 −2 −1 −4 −1 −2 −3 −3 −3
10. (i) , , (ii) , , (iii) , ,
5 5 5 3 3 9 2 4 7
2020-21
ANSWERS 303
EXERCISE 9.2
−3 34 17 82
1. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
2 15 30 99
−26 −2 34
(v) (vi) (vii)
57 3 15
−13 23 1 −89 −73
2. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v)
72 63 195 88 9
d
−3 4 −1 −14
he
4. (i) –6 (ii) (iii) (iv) (v)
10 pu T 15 6 13
is
re ER
91 −15
(vi) (vii)
24 4
bl
be NC
EXERCISE 11.1
1. (i) 150000 m2 (ii) ` 1,500,000,000
©
EXERCISE 11.2
tt
1. (a) 28 cm2 (b) 15 cm2 (c) 8.75 cm2 (d) 24 cm2 (e) 8.8 cm2
no
EXERCISE 11.3
1. (a) 88 cm (b) 176 mm (c) 132 cm
550
2. (a) 616 mm2 (b) 1886.5 m2 (c) cm2
7
2020-21
304 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 11.4
1. 1750 m2 ; 0.675 ha 2. 1176 m2 3. 30 cm2
2
4. (i) 63 m (ii) ` 12,600 5. (i) 116 m2 (ii) ` 31,360
6. 0.99 ha; 20.01 ha 7. (i) 441 m2 (ii) ` 48,510 8. Yes, 9.12 cm cord is left
2 2
9. (i) 50m (ii) 12.56 m (iii) 37.44m2 (iv) 12.56m
2
10. (i) 110 cm (ii) 150 cm2; 11. 66 cm2
EXERCISE 12.1
d
he
1 pu T 1
1. (i) y–z (ii) (x + y) (iii) z 2 (iv) pq (v) x2 + y2 (vi) 5 + 3mn
is
2 4
re ER
(vii) 10 – yz (viii) ab – (a + b)
bl
be NC
(d) (e)
o
tt
no
(a) – 4x + 5 – 4x – 4, x
5 5
(b) – 4x + 5y – 4x – 4,x
5y 5,y
(c) 5y + 3y2 5y 5,y
3y 2 3,y,y
(d) xy+2x 2y 2 xy x, y
2x 2 y 2 2, x, x, y, y
(e) pq + q pq p, q
q q
2020-21
ANSWERS 305
d
(i) 5 – 3t2 – 3 t2 –3
he
(ii) 1 + t + t2 + t3 pu T t 1
is
re ER
t2 1
bl t3 1
(iii) x + 2xy + 3y x 1
be NC
2xy 2
3y 3
©
7pq 7
tt
0.8 b 0.8
(vii) 3.14r2 3.14r2 3.14
(viii) 2(l + b) 2l 2
2b 2
(ix) 0.1y + 0.01y2 0.1y 0.1
0.01y2 0.01
(iii) x+y+2 x 1
(iv) 5 + z + zx zx z
2020-21
306 MATHEMATICS
(v) 1 + x + xy x 1
xy y
(vi) 12xy2 + 25 12xy2 12y2
(vii) 7 + xy2 xy 2 y2
d
5. (i) binomial (ii) monomial (iii) trinomial (iv) monomial
he
(v) trinomial (vi) binomial pu T (vii) binomial (viii) monomial
is
re ER
(ix) trinomial (x) binomial (xi) binomial (xii) trinomial
6. (i) like (ii) like
bl (iii) unlike (iv) like
be NC
EXERCISE 12.2
o
EXERCISE 12.3
1. (i) 0 (ii) 1 (iii) –1 (iv) 1 (v) 1
2. (i) –1 (ii) –13 (iii) 3 3. (i) –9 (ii) 3 (iii) 0 (iv) 1
2020-21
ANSWERS 307
EXERCISE 12.4
d
10th : 41;
he
5 pu T 16 100th : 401
is
re ER
10 31 (iv) 7n + 20 → 5th : 55;
10th : 90;
100
bl 301
100th : 720
be NC
100 502
EXERCISE 13.1
o
4 2 4
2. (i) 6 (ii) t (iii) b (iv) 52 × 73 (v) 22 × a2 (vi) a3 × c4 × d
no
EXERCISE 13.2
14 5
1. (i) 3 (ii) 6 (iii) a 5 (iv) 7x + 2 (v) 53 (vi) (10)5
(vii) (ab) 4 (viii) 3 12 (ix) 28 (x) 8t – 2
2. (i) 33 (ii) 53 (iii) 55 (iv) 7 × 115 (v) 30 or 1 (vi) 3
2 10 3
(vii) 1 (viii) 2 (ix) (2a) (x) a (xi) a b (xii) 28
2020-21
308 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 13.3
1. 279404 = 2 × 105 + 7 × 104 + 9 × 103 + 4 × 102 + 0 × 101 + 4 × 100
3006194 = 3 × 106 + 0 × 105 + 0 × 104 + 6 × 103 + 1 × 102 + 9 × 101 + 4 × 100
2806196 = 2 × 106 + 8 × 105 + 0 × 104 + 6 × 103 + 1 × 102 + 9 × 101+ 6 × 100
120719 = 1 × 105 + 2 × 104 + 0 × 103 + 7 × 102 + 1 × 101 + 9 × 100
20068 = 2 × 104 + 0 × 103 + 0 × 102 + 6 × 101 + 8 × 100
2. (a) 86045 (b) 405302 (c) 30705 (d) 900230
d
7 6 9
3. (i) 5 × 10 (ii) 7 × 10 (iii) 3.1865 × 10 (iv) 3.90878 × 105
he
(v) 3.90878 × 104 (vi) 3.90878 × 103 pu T
is
re ER
4. (a) 3.84 × 108m (b) 3 × 108 m/s (c) 1.2756 × 107m (d) 1.4 × 109 m
(e) 1 × 1011
bl
(f) 1.2 × 1010 years (g) 3 × 1020 m (h) 6.023 × 1022
(i) 1.353 × 109 km3 (j) 1.027 × 109
be NC
EXERCISE 14.1
©
1.
o
tt
no
2020-21
ANSWERS 309
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
(j) bl (k) (l)
be NC
2.
©
(d) (e)
3.
2020-21
310 MATHEMATICS
4.
d
he
(a) pu T (b) (c) (d)
is
re ER
bl
be NC
©
8. (a) A, H, I, M, O, T, U, V, W, X, Y (b) B, C, D, E, H, I, O, X
no
(c) O, X, I, H
10. (a) Median (b) Diameter
EXERCISE 14.2
1. (a), (b), (d), (e), (f)
2. (a) 2 (b) 2 (c) 3 (d) 4 (e) 4 (f) 5
(g) 6 (h) 3
EXERCISE 14.3
3. Yes 5. Square 6. 120°, 180°, 240°, 300°, 360°
7. (i) Yes (ii) No
EXERCISE 15.1
1. Nets in (ii), (iii), (iv), (vi) form cubes.
2020-21
ANSWERS 311
2. 1 1 2
3 2 4 5 5 3
6 4 6
3. No, because one pair of opposite faces will have 1 and 4 on them whose total is not 7, and another pair
of opposite faces will have 3 and 6 on them whose total is also not 7.
4. Three faces
d
he
pu T
is
re ER
bl
5. (a) (ii) (b) (iii) (c) (iv) (d) (i)
be NC
©
BRAIN-TEASERS
o
2020-21
312 MATHEMATICS
(ii) I have some five-rupee coins and some two-rupee coins. The number of
two-rupee coins is twice the number of five-rupee coins. The total money I have
is 108 rupees. So how many five-rupee coins do I have? And how many
two-rupee coins?
3. I have 2 vats each containing 2 mats. 2 cats sat on each of the mats. Each cat wore 2
funny old hats. On each hat lay 2 thin rats. On each rat perched 2 black bats. How
many things are in my vats?
4. Twenty-seven small cubes are glued together to make a big cube. The exterior of the
big cube is painted yellow in colour. How many among each of the 27 small cubes
would have been painted yellow on
(i) only one of its faces?
(ii) two of its faces?
(iii) three of its faces?
5. Rahul wanted to find the height of a tree in his garden. He checked the ratio of his
height to his shadow’s length. It was 4:1. He then measured the shadow of the tree. It
d
was 15 feet. So what was the height of the tree?
he
6. A woodcutter took 12 minutes to make 3 pieces of a block of wood. How much time
pu T
would be needed to make 5 such pieces?
is
re ER
7. A cloth shrinks 0.5% when washed. What fraction is this?
bl
8. Smita’s mother is 34 years old. Two years from now mother’s age will be 4 times
be NC
Answers
1. (i) 140 (ii) 10
o
1
6. 24 minutes 7. 8. 7 years 9. 21
200
2020-21